]> code.delx.au - gnu-emacs/blob - man/texinfo.tex
(enum event_kind) [MAC_OS]: Update comment for MAC_APPLE_EVENT.
[gnu-emacs] / man / texinfo.tex
1 % texinfo.tex -- TeX macros to handle Texinfo files.
2 %
3 % Load plain if necessary, i.e., if running under initex.
4 \expandafter\ifx\csname fmtname\endcsname\relax\input plain\fi
5 %
6 \def\texinfoversion{2006-03-21.13}
7 %
8 % Copyright (C) 1985, 1986, 1988, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
9 % 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006 Free
10 % Software Foundation, Inc.
11 %
12 % This texinfo.tex file is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
13 % modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as
14 % published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at
15 % your option) any later version.
16 %
17 % This texinfo.tex file is distributed in the hope that it will be
18 % useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty
19 % of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
20 % General Public License for more details.
21 %
22 % You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
23 % along with this texinfo.tex file; see the file COPYING. If not, write
24 % to the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
25 % Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA.
26 %
27 % As a special exception, when this file is read by TeX when processing
28 % a Texinfo source document, you may use the result without
29 % restriction. (This has been our intent since Texinfo was invented.)
30 %
31 % Please try the latest version of texinfo.tex before submitting bug
32 % reports; you can get the latest version from:
33 % http://www.gnu.org/software/texinfo/ (the Texinfo home page), or
34 % ftp://tug.org/tex/texinfo.tex
35 % (and all CTAN mirrors, see http://www.ctan.org).
36 % The texinfo.tex in any given distribution could well be out
37 % of date, so if that's what you're using, please check.
38 %
39 % Send bug reports to bug-texinfo@gnu.org. Please include including a
40 % complete document in each bug report with which we can reproduce the
41 % problem. Patches are, of course, greatly appreciated.
42 %
43 % To process a Texinfo manual with TeX, it's most reliable to use the
44 % texi2dvi shell script that comes with the distribution. For a simple
45 % manual foo.texi, however, you can get away with this:
46 % tex foo.texi
47 % texindex foo.??
48 % tex foo.texi
49 % tex foo.texi
50 % dvips foo.dvi -o # or whatever; this makes foo.ps.
51 % The extra TeX runs get the cross-reference information correct.
52 % Sometimes one run after texindex suffices, and sometimes you need more
53 % than two; texi2dvi does it as many times as necessary.
54 %
55 % It is possible to adapt texinfo.tex for other languages, to some
56 % extent. You can get the existing language-specific files from the
57 % full Texinfo distribution.
58 %
59 % The GNU Texinfo home page is http://www.gnu.org/software/texinfo.
60
61
62 \message{Loading texinfo [version \texinfoversion]:}
63
64 % If in a .fmt file, print the version number
65 % and turn on active characters that we couldn't do earlier because
66 % they might have appeared in the input file name.
67 \everyjob{\message{[Texinfo version \texinfoversion]}%
68 \catcode`+=\active \catcode`\_=\active}
69
70 \message{Basics,}
71 \chardef\other=12
72
73 % We never want plain's \outer definition of \+ in Texinfo.
74 % For @tex, we can use \tabalign.
75 \let\+ = \relax
76
77 % Save some plain tex macros whose names we will redefine.
78 \let\ptexb=\b
79 \let\ptexbullet=\bullet
80 \let\ptexc=\c
81 \let\ptexcomma=\,
82 \let\ptexdot=\.
83 \let\ptexdots=\dots
84 \let\ptexend=\end
85 \let\ptexequiv=\equiv
86 \let\ptexexclam=\!
87 \let\ptexfootnote=\footnote
88 \let\ptexgtr=>
89 \let\ptexhat=^
90 \let\ptexi=\i
91 \let\ptexindent=\indent
92 \let\ptexinsert=\insert
93 \let\ptexlbrace=\{
94 \let\ptexless=<
95 \let\ptexnewwrite\newwrite
96 \let\ptexnoindent=\noindent
97 \let\ptexplus=+
98 \let\ptexrbrace=\}
99 \let\ptexslash=\/
100 \let\ptexstar=\*
101 \let\ptext=\t
102
103 % If this character appears in an error message or help string, it
104 % starts a new line in the output.
105 \newlinechar = `^^J
106
107 % Use TeX 3.0's \inputlineno to get the line number, for better error
108 % messages, but if we're using an old version of TeX, don't do anything.
109 %
110 \ifx\inputlineno\thisisundefined
111 \let\linenumber = \empty % Pre-3.0.
112 \else
113 \def\linenumber{l.\the\inputlineno:\space}
114 \fi
115
116 % Set up fixed words for English if not already set.
117 \ifx\putwordAppendix\undefined \gdef\putwordAppendix{Appendix}\fi
118 \ifx\putwordChapter\undefined \gdef\putwordChapter{Chapter}\fi
119 \ifx\putwordfile\undefined \gdef\putwordfile{file}\fi
120 \ifx\putwordin\undefined \gdef\putwordin{in}\fi
121 \ifx\putwordIndexIsEmpty\undefined \gdef\putwordIndexIsEmpty{(Index is empty)}\fi
122 \ifx\putwordIndexNonexistent\undefined \gdef\putwordIndexNonexistent{(Index is nonexistent)}\fi
123 \ifx\putwordInfo\undefined \gdef\putwordInfo{Info}\fi
124 \ifx\putwordInstanceVariableof\undefined \gdef\putwordInstanceVariableof{Instance Variable of}\fi
125 \ifx\putwordMethodon\undefined \gdef\putwordMethodon{Method on}\fi
126 \ifx\putwordNoTitle\undefined \gdef\putwordNoTitle{No Title}\fi
127 \ifx\putwordof\undefined \gdef\putwordof{of}\fi
128 \ifx\putwordon\undefined \gdef\putwordon{on}\fi
129 \ifx\putwordpage\undefined \gdef\putwordpage{page}\fi
130 \ifx\putwordsection\undefined \gdef\putwordsection{section}\fi
131 \ifx\putwordSection\undefined \gdef\putwordSection{Section}\fi
132 \ifx\putwordsee\undefined \gdef\putwordsee{see}\fi
133 \ifx\putwordSee\undefined \gdef\putwordSee{See}\fi
134 \ifx\putwordShortTOC\undefined \gdef\putwordShortTOC{Short Contents}\fi
135 \ifx\putwordTOC\undefined \gdef\putwordTOC{Table of Contents}\fi
136 %
137 \ifx\putwordMJan\undefined \gdef\putwordMJan{January}\fi
138 \ifx\putwordMFeb\undefined \gdef\putwordMFeb{February}\fi
139 \ifx\putwordMMar\undefined \gdef\putwordMMar{March}\fi
140 \ifx\putwordMApr\undefined \gdef\putwordMApr{April}\fi
141 \ifx\putwordMMay\undefined \gdef\putwordMMay{May}\fi
142 \ifx\putwordMJun\undefined \gdef\putwordMJun{June}\fi
143 \ifx\putwordMJul\undefined \gdef\putwordMJul{July}\fi
144 \ifx\putwordMAug\undefined \gdef\putwordMAug{August}\fi
145 \ifx\putwordMSep\undefined \gdef\putwordMSep{September}\fi
146 \ifx\putwordMOct\undefined \gdef\putwordMOct{October}\fi
147 \ifx\putwordMNov\undefined \gdef\putwordMNov{November}\fi
148 \ifx\putwordMDec\undefined \gdef\putwordMDec{December}\fi
149 %
150 \ifx\putwordDefmac\undefined \gdef\putwordDefmac{Macro}\fi
151 \ifx\putwordDefspec\undefined \gdef\putwordDefspec{Special Form}\fi
152 \ifx\putwordDefvar\undefined \gdef\putwordDefvar{Variable}\fi
153 \ifx\putwordDefopt\undefined \gdef\putwordDefopt{User Option}\fi
154 \ifx\putwordDeffunc\undefined \gdef\putwordDeffunc{Function}\fi
155
156 % Since the category of space is not known, we have to be careful.
157 \chardef\spacecat = 10
158 \def\spaceisspace{\catcode`\ =\spacecat}
159
160 % Ignore a token.
161 %
162 \def\gobble#1{}
163
164 % The following is used inside several \edef's.
165 \def\makecsname#1{\expandafter\noexpand\csname#1\endcsname}
166
167 % Hyphenation fixes.
168 \hyphenation{
169 Flor-i-da Ghost-script Ghost-view Mac-OS Post-Script
170 ap-pen-dix bit-map bit-maps
171 data-base data-bases eshell fall-ing half-way long-est man-u-script
172 man-u-scripts mini-buf-fer mini-buf-fers over-view par-a-digm
173 par-a-digms rath-er rec-tan-gu-lar ro-bot-ics se-vere-ly set-up spa-ces
174 spell-ing spell-ings
175 stand-alone strong-est time-stamp time-stamps which-ever white-space
176 wide-spread wrap-around
177 }
178
179 % Margin to add to right of even pages, to left of odd pages.
180 \newdimen\bindingoffset
181 \newdimen\normaloffset
182 \newdimen\pagewidth \newdimen\pageheight
183
184 % For a final copy, take out the rectangles
185 % that mark overfull boxes (in case you have decided
186 % that the text looks ok even though it passes the margin).
187 %
188 \def\finalout{\overfullrule=0pt}
189
190 % @| inserts a changebar to the left of the current line. It should
191 % surround any changed text. This approach does *not* work if the
192 % change spans more than two lines of output. To handle that, we would
193 % have adopt a much more difficult approach (putting marks into the main
194 % vertical list for the beginning and end of each change).
195 %
196 \def\|{%
197 % \vadjust can only be used in horizontal mode.
198 \leavevmode
199 %
200 % Append this vertical mode material after the current line in the output.
201 \vadjust{%
202 % We want to insert a rule with the height and depth of the current
203 % leading; that is exactly what \strutbox is supposed to record.
204 \vskip-\baselineskip
205 %
206 % \vadjust-items are inserted at the left edge of the type. So
207 % the \llap here moves out into the left-hand margin.
208 \llap{%
209 %
210 % For a thicker or thinner bar, change the `1pt'.
211 \vrule height\baselineskip width1pt
212 %
213 % This is the space between the bar and the text.
214 \hskip 12pt
215 }%
216 }%
217 }
218
219 % Sometimes it is convenient to have everything in the transcript file
220 % and nothing on the terminal. We don't just call \tracingall here,
221 % since that produces some useless output on the terminal. We also make
222 % some effort to order the tracing commands to reduce output in the log
223 % file; cf. trace.sty in LaTeX.
224 %
225 \def\gloggingall{\begingroup \globaldefs = 1 \loggingall \endgroup}%
226 \def\loggingall{%
227 \tracingstats2
228 \tracingpages1
229 \tracinglostchars2 % 2 gives us more in etex
230 \tracingparagraphs1
231 \tracingoutput1
232 \tracingmacros2
233 \tracingrestores1
234 \showboxbreadth\maxdimen \showboxdepth\maxdimen
235 \ifx\eTeXversion\undefined\else % etex gives us more logging
236 \tracingscantokens1
237 \tracingifs1
238 \tracinggroups1
239 \tracingnesting2
240 \tracingassigns1
241 \fi
242 \tracingcommands3 % 3 gives us more in etex
243 \errorcontextlines16
244 }%
245
246 % add check for \lastpenalty to plain's definitions. If the last thing
247 % we did was a \nobreak, we don't want to insert more space.
248 %
249 \def\smallbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<\smallskipamount
250 \removelastskip\penalty-50\smallskip\fi\fi}
251 \def\medbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<\medskipamount
252 \removelastskip\penalty-100\medskip\fi\fi}
253 \def\bigbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<\bigskipamount
254 \removelastskip\penalty-200\bigskip\fi\fi}
255
256 % For @cropmarks command.
257 % Do @cropmarks to get crop marks.
258 %
259 \newif\ifcropmarks
260 \let\cropmarks = \cropmarkstrue
261 %
262 % Dimensions to add cropmarks at corners.
263 % Added by P. A. MacKay, 12 Nov. 1986
264 %
265 \newdimen\outerhsize \newdimen\outervsize % set by the paper size routines
266 \newdimen\cornerlong \cornerlong=1pc
267 \newdimen\cornerthick \cornerthick=.3pt
268 \newdimen\topandbottommargin \topandbottommargin=.75in
269
270 % Main output routine.
271 \chardef\PAGE = 255
272 \output = {\onepageout{\pagecontents\PAGE}}
273
274 \newbox\headlinebox
275 \newbox\footlinebox
276
277 % \onepageout takes a vbox as an argument. Note that \pagecontents
278 % does insertions, but you have to call it yourself.
279 \def\onepageout#1{%
280 \ifcropmarks \hoffset=0pt \else \hoffset=\normaloffset \fi
281 %
282 \ifodd\pageno \advance\hoffset by \bindingoffset
283 \else \advance\hoffset by -\bindingoffset\fi
284 %
285 % Do this outside of the \shipout so @code etc. will be expanded in
286 % the headline as they should be, not taken literally (outputting ''code).
287 \setbox\headlinebox = \vbox{\let\hsize=\pagewidth \makeheadline}%
288 \setbox\footlinebox = \vbox{\let\hsize=\pagewidth \makefootline}%
289 %
290 {%
291 % Have to do this stuff outside the \shipout because we want it to
292 % take effect in \write's, yet the group defined by the \vbox ends
293 % before the \shipout runs.
294 %
295 \indexdummies % don't expand commands in the output.
296 \normalturnoffactive % \ in index entries must not stay \, e.g., if
297 % the page break happens to be in the middle of an example.
298 % We don't want .vr (or whatever) entries like this:
299 % \entry{{\tt \indexbackslash }acronym}{32}{\code {\acronym}}
300 % "\acronym" won't work when it's read back in;
301 % it needs to be
302 % {\code {{\tt \backslashcurfont }acronym}
303 \shipout\vbox{%
304 % Do this early so pdf references go to the beginning of the page.
305 \ifpdfmakepagedest \pdfdest name{\the\pageno} xyz\fi
306 %
307 \ifcropmarks \vbox to \outervsize\bgroup
308 \hsize = \outerhsize
309 \vskip-\topandbottommargin
310 \vtop to0pt{%
311 \line{\ewtop\hfil\ewtop}%
312 \nointerlineskip
313 \line{%
314 \vbox{\moveleft\cornerthick\nstop}%
315 \hfill
316 \vbox{\moveright\cornerthick\nstop}%
317 }%
318 \vss}%
319 \vskip\topandbottommargin
320 \line\bgroup
321 \hfil % center the page within the outer (page) hsize.
322 \ifodd\pageno\hskip\bindingoffset\fi
323 \vbox\bgroup
324 \fi
325 %
326 \unvbox\headlinebox
327 \pagebody{#1}%
328 \ifdim\ht\footlinebox > 0pt
329 % Only leave this space if the footline is nonempty.
330 % (We lessened \vsize for it in \oddfootingxxx.)
331 % The \baselineskip=24pt in plain's \makefootline has no effect.
332 \vskip 2\baselineskip
333 \unvbox\footlinebox
334 \fi
335 %
336 \ifcropmarks
337 \egroup % end of \vbox\bgroup
338 \hfil\egroup % end of (centering) \line\bgroup
339 \vskip\topandbottommargin plus1fill minus1fill
340 \boxmaxdepth = \cornerthick
341 \vbox to0pt{\vss
342 \line{%
343 \vbox{\moveleft\cornerthick\nsbot}%
344 \hfill
345 \vbox{\moveright\cornerthick\nsbot}%
346 }%
347 \nointerlineskip
348 \line{\ewbot\hfil\ewbot}%
349 }%
350 \egroup % \vbox from first cropmarks clause
351 \fi
352 }% end of \shipout\vbox
353 }% end of group with \indexdummies
354 \advancepageno
355 \ifnum\outputpenalty>-20000 \else\dosupereject\fi
356 }
357
358 \newinsert\margin \dimen\margin=\maxdimen
359
360 \def\pagebody#1{\vbox to\pageheight{\boxmaxdepth=\maxdepth #1}}
361 {\catcode`\@ =11
362 \gdef\pagecontents#1{\ifvoid\topins\else\unvbox\topins\fi
363 % marginal hacks, juha@viisa.uucp (Juha Takala)
364 \ifvoid\margin\else % marginal info is present
365 \rlap{\kern\hsize\vbox to\z@{\kern1pt\box\margin \vss}}\fi
366 \dimen@=\dp#1 \unvbox#1
367 \ifvoid\footins\else\vskip\skip\footins\footnoterule \unvbox\footins\fi
368 \ifr@ggedbottom \kern-\dimen@ \vfil \fi}
369 }
370
371 % Here are the rules for the cropmarks. Note that they are
372 % offset so that the space between them is truly \outerhsize or \outervsize
373 % (P. A. MacKay, 12 November, 1986)
374 %
375 \def\ewtop{\vrule height\cornerthick depth0pt width\cornerlong}
376 \def\nstop{\vbox
377 {\hrule height\cornerthick depth\cornerlong width\cornerthick}}
378 \def\ewbot{\vrule height0pt depth\cornerthick width\cornerlong}
379 \def\nsbot{\vbox
380 {\hrule height\cornerlong depth\cornerthick width\cornerthick}}
381
382 % Parse an argument, then pass it to #1. The argument is the rest of
383 % the input line (except we remove a trailing comment). #1 should be a
384 % macro which expects an ordinary undelimited TeX argument.
385 %
386 \def\parsearg{\parseargusing{}}
387 \def\parseargusing#1#2{%
388 \def\argtorun{#2}%
389 \begingroup
390 \obeylines
391 \spaceisspace
392 #1%
393 \parseargline\empty% Insert the \empty token, see \finishparsearg below.
394 }
395
396 {\obeylines %
397 \gdef\parseargline#1^^M{%
398 \endgroup % End of the group started in \parsearg.
399 \argremovecomment #1\comment\ArgTerm%
400 }%
401 }
402
403 % First remove any @comment, then any @c comment.
404 \def\argremovecomment#1\comment#2\ArgTerm{\argremovec #1\c\ArgTerm}
405 \def\argremovec#1\c#2\ArgTerm{\argcheckspaces#1\^^M\ArgTerm}
406
407 % Each occurence of `\^^M' or `<space>\^^M' is replaced by a single space.
408 %
409 % \argremovec might leave us with trailing space, e.g.,
410 % @end itemize @c foo
411 % This space token undergoes the same procedure and is eventually removed
412 % by \finishparsearg.
413 %
414 \def\argcheckspaces#1\^^M{\argcheckspacesX#1\^^M \^^M}
415 \def\argcheckspacesX#1 \^^M{\argcheckspacesY#1\^^M}
416 \def\argcheckspacesY#1\^^M#2\^^M#3\ArgTerm{%
417 \def\temp{#3}%
418 \ifx\temp\empty
419 % Do not use \next, perhaps the caller of \parsearg uses it; reuse \temp:
420 \let\temp\finishparsearg
421 \else
422 \let\temp\argcheckspaces
423 \fi
424 % Put the space token in:
425 \temp#1 #3\ArgTerm
426 }
427
428 % If a _delimited_ argument is enclosed in braces, they get stripped; so
429 % to get _exactly_ the rest of the line, we had to prevent such situation.
430 % We prepended an \empty token at the very beginning and we expand it now,
431 % just before passing the control to \argtorun.
432 % (Similarily, we have to think about #3 of \argcheckspacesY above: it is
433 % either the null string, or it ends with \^^M---thus there is no danger
434 % that a pair of braces would be stripped.
435 %
436 % But first, we have to remove the trailing space token.
437 %
438 \def\finishparsearg#1 \ArgTerm{\expandafter\argtorun\expandafter{#1}}
439
440 % \parseargdef\foo{...}
441 % is roughly equivalent to
442 % \def\foo{\parsearg\Xfoo}
443 % \def\Xfoo#1{...}
444 %
445 % Actually, I use \csname\string\foo\endcsname, ie. \\foo, as it is my
446 % favourite TeX trick. --kasal, 16nov03
447
448 \def\parseargdef#1{%
449 \expandafter \doparseargdef \csname\string#1\endcsname #1%
450 }
451 \def\doparseargdef#1#2{%
452 \def#2{\parsearg#1}%
453 \def#1##1%
454 }
455
456 % Several utility definitions with active space:
457 {
458 \obeyspaces
459 \gdef\obeyedspace{ }
460
461 % Make each space character in the input produce a normal interword
462 % space in the output. Don't allow a line break at this space, as this
463 % is used only in environments like @example, where each line of input
464 % should produce a line of output anyway.
465 %
466 \gdef\sepspaces{\obeyspaces\let =\tie}
467
468 % If an index command is used in an @example environment, any spaces
469 % therein should become regular spaces in the raw index file, not the
470 % expansion of \tie (\leavevmode \penalty \@M \ ).
471 \gdef\unsepspaces{\let =\space}
472 }
473
474
475 \def\flushcr{\ifx\par\lisppar \def\next##1{}\else \let\next=\relax \fi \next}
476
477 % Define the framework for environments in texinfo.tex. It's used like this:
478 %
479 % \envdef\foo{...}
480 % \def\Efoo{...}
481 %
482 % It's the responsibility of \envdef to insert \begingroup before the
483 % actual body; @end closes the group after calling \Efoo. \envdef also
484 % defines \thisenv, so the current environment is known; @end checks
485 % whether the environment name matches. The \checkenv macro can also be
486 % used to check whether the current environment is the one expected.
487 %
488 % Non-false conditionals (@iftex, @ifset) don't fit into this, so they
489 % are not treated as enviroments; they don't open a group. (The
490 % implementation of @end takes care not to call \endgroup in this
491 % special case.)
492
493
494 % At runtime, environments start with this:
495 \def\startenvironment#1{\begingroup\def\thisenv{#1}}
496 % initialize
497 \let\thisenv\empty
498
499 % ... but they get defined via ``\envdef\foo{...}'':
500 \long\def\envdef#1#2{\def#1{\startenvironment#1#2}}
501 \def\envparseargdef#1#2{\parseargdef#1{\startenvironment#1#2}}
502
503 % Check whether we're in the right environment:
504 \def\checkenv#1{%
505 \def\temp{#1}%
506 \ifx\thisenv\temp
507 \else
508 \badenverr
509 \fi
510 }
511
512 % Evironment mismatch, #1 expected:
513 \def\badenverr{%
514 \errhelp = \EMsimple
515 \errmessage{This command can appear only \inenvironment\temp,
516 not \inenvironment\thisenv}%
517 }
518 \def\inenvironment#1{%
519 \ifx#1\empty
520 out of any environment%
521 \else
522 in environment \expandafter\string#1%
523 \fi
524 }
525
526 % @end foo executes the definition of \Efoo.
527 % But first, it executes a specialized version of \checkenv
528 %
529 \parseargdef\end{%
530 \if 1\csname iscond.#1\endcsname
531 \else
532 % The general wording of \badenverr may not be ideal, but... --kasal, 06nov03
533 \expandafter\checkenv\csname#1\endcsname
534 \csname E#1\endcsname
535 \endgroup
536 \fi
537 }
538
539 \newhelp\EMsimple{Press RETURN to continue.}
540
541
542 %% Simple single-character @ commands
543
544 % @@ prints an @
545 % Kludge this until the fonts are right (grr).
546 \def\@{{\tt\char64}}
547
548 % This is turned off because it was never documented
549 % and you can use @w{...} around a quote to suppress ligatures.
550 %% Define @` and @' to be the same as ` and '
551 %% but suppressing ligatures.
552 %\def\`{{`}}
553 %\def\'{{'}}
554
555 % Used to generate quoted braces.
556 \def\mylbrace {{\tt\char123}}
557 \def\myrbrace {{\tt\char125}}
558 \let\{=\mylbrace
559 \let\}=\myrbrace
560 \begingroup
561 % Definitions to produce \{ and \} commands for indices,
562 % and @{ and @} for the aux/toc files.
563 \catcode`\{ = \other \catcode`\} = \other
564 \catcode`\[ = 1 \catcode`\] = 2
565 \catcode`\! = 0 \catcode`\\ = \other
566 !gdef!lbracecmd[\{]%
567 !gdef!rbracecmd[\}]%
568 !gdef!lbraceatcmd[@{]%
569 !gdef!rbraceatcmd[@}]%
570 !endgroup
571
572 % @comma{} to avoid , parsing problems.
573 \let\comma = ,
574
575 % Accents: @, @dotaccent @ringaccent @ubaraccent @udotaccent
576 % Others are defined by plain TeX: @` @' @" @^ @~ @= @u @v @H.
577 \let\, = \c
578 \let\dotaccent = \.
579 \def\ringaccent#1{{\accent23 #1}}
580 \let\tieaccent = \t
581 \let\ubaraccent = \b
582 \let\udotaccent = \d
583
584 % Other special characters: @questiondown @exclamdown @ordf @ordm
585 % Plain TeX defines: @AA @AE @O @OE @L (plus lowercase versions) @ss.
586 \def\questiondown{?`}
587 \def\exclamdown{!`}
588 \def\ordf{\leavevmode\raise1ex\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize \underbar{a}}}
589 \def\ordm{\leavevmode\raise1ex\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize \underbar{o}}}
590
591 % Dotless i and dotless j, used for accents.
592 \def\imacro{i}
593 \def\jmacro{j}
594 \def\dotless#1{%
595 \def\temp{#1}%
596 \ifx\temp\imacro \ptexi
597 \else\ifx\temp\jmacro \j
598 \else \errmessage{@dotless can be used only with i or j}%
599 \fi\fi
600 }
601
602 % The \TeX{} logo, as in plain, but resetting the spacing so that a
603 % period following counts as ending a sentence. (Idea found in latex.)
604 %
605 \edef\TeX{\TeX \spacefactor=1000 }
606
607 % @LaTeX{} logo. Not quite the same results as the definition in
608 % latex.ltx, since we use a different font for the raised A; it's most
609 % convenient for us to use an explicitly smaller font, rather than using
610 % the \scriptstyle font (since we don't reset \scriptstyle and
611 % \scriptscriptstyle).
612 %
613 \def\LaTeX{%
614 L\kern-.36em
615 {\setbox0=\hbox{T}%
616 \vbox to \ht0{\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize A}\vss}}%
617 \kern-.15em
618 \TeX
619 }
620
621 % Be sure we're in horizontal mode when doing a tie, since we make space
622 % equivalent to this in @example-like environments. Otherwise, a space
623 % at the beginning of a line will start with \penalty -- and
624 % since \penalty is valid in vertical mode, we'd end up putting the
625 % penalty on the vertical list instead of in the new paragraph.
626 {\catcode`@ = 11
627 % Avoid using \@M directly, because that causes trouble
628 % if the definition is written into an index file.
629 \global\let\tiepenalty = \@M
630 \gdef\tie{\leavevmode\penalty\tiepenalty\ }
631 }
632
633 % @: forces normal size whitespace following.
634 \def\:{\spacefactor=1000 }
635
636 % @* forces a line break.
637 \def\*{\hfil\break\hbox{}\ignorespaces}
638
639 % @/ allows a line break.
640 \let\/=\allowbreak
641
642 % @. is an end-of-sentence period.
643 \def\.{.\spacefactor=\endofsentencespacefactor\space}
644
645 % @! is an end-of-sentence bang.
646 \def\!{!\spacefactor=\endofsentencespacefactor\space}
647
648 % @? is an end-of-sentence query.
649 \def\?{?\spacefactor=\endofsentencespacefactor\space}
650
651 % @frenchspacing on|off says whether to put extra space after punctuation.
652 %
653 \def\onword{on}
654 \def\offword{off}
655 %
656 \parseargdef\frenchspacing{%
657 \def\temp{#1}%
658 \ifx\temp\onword \plainfrenchspacing
659 \else\ifx\temp\offword \plainnonfrenchspacing
660 \else
661 \errhelp = \EMsimple
662 \errmessage{Unknown @frenchspacing option `\temp', must be on/off}%
663 \fi\fi
664 }
665
666 % @w prevents a word break. Without the \leavevmode, @w at the
667 % beginning of a paragraph, when TeX is still in vertical mode, would
668 % produce a whole line of output instead of starting the paragraph.
669 \def\w#1{\leavevmode\hbox{#1}}
670
671 % @group ... @end group forces ... to be all on one page, by enclosing
672 % it in a TeX vbox. We use \vtop instead of \vbox to construct the box
673 % to keep its height that of a normal line. According to the rules for
674 % \topskip (p.114 of the TeXbook), the glue inserted is
675 % max (\topskip - \ht (first item), 0). If that height is large,
676 % therefore, no glue is inserted, and the space between the headline and
677 % the text is small, which looks bad.
678 %
679 % Another complication is that the group might be very large. This can
680 % cause the glue on the previous page to be unduly stretched, because it
681 % does not have much material. In this case, it's better to add an
682 % explicit \vfill so that the extra space is at the bottom. The
683 % threshold for doing this is if the group is more than \vfilllimit
684 % percent of a page (\vfilllimit can be changed inside of @tex).
685 %
686 \newbox\groupbox
687 \def\vfilllimit{0.7}
688 %
689 \envdef\group{%
690 \ifnum\catcode`\^^M=\active \else
691 \errhelp = \groupinvalidhelp
692 \errmessage{@group invalid in context where filling is enabled}%
693 \fi
694 \startsavinginserts
695 %
696 \setbox\groupbox = \vtop\bgroup
697 % Do @comment since we are called inside an environment such as
698 % @example, where each end-of-line in the input causes an
699 % end-of-line in the output. We don't want the end-of-line after
700 % the `@group' to put extra space in the output. Since @group
701 % should appear on a line by itself (according to the Texinfo
702 % manual), we don't worry about eating any user text.
703 \comment
704 }
705 %
706 % The \vtop produces a box with normal height and large depth; thus, TeX puts
707 % \baselineskip glue before it, and (when the next line of text is done)
708 % \lineskip glue after it. Thus, space below is not quite equal to space
709 % above. But it's pretty close.
710 \def\Egroup{%
711 % To get correct interline space between the last line of the group
712 % and the first line afterwards, we have to propagate \prevdepth.
713 \endgraf % Not \par, as it may have been set to \lisppar.
714 \global\dimen1 = \prevdepth
715 \egroup % End the \vtop.
716 % \dimen0 is the vertical size of the group's box.
717 \dimen0 = \ht\groupbox \advance\dimen0 by \dp\groupbox
718 % \dimen2 is how much space is left on the page (more or less).
719 \dimen2 = \pageheight \advance\dimen2 by -\pagetotal
720 % if the group doesn't fit on the current page, and it's a big big
721 % group, force a page break.
722 \ifdim \dimen0 > \dimen2
723 \ifdim \pagetotal < \vfilllimit\pageheight
724 \page
725 \fi
726 \fi
727 \box\groupbox
728 \prevdepth = \dimen1
729 \checkinserts
730 }
731 %
732 % TeX puts in an \escapechar (i.e., `@') at the beginning of the help
733 % message, so this ends up printing `@group can only ...'.
734 %
735 \newhelp\groupinvalidhelp{%
736 group can only be used in environments such as @example,^^J%
737 where each line of input produces a line of output.}
738
739 % @need space-in-mils
740 % forces a page break if there is not space-in-mils remaining.
741
742 \newdimen\mil \mil=0.001in
743
744 % Old definition--didn't work.
745 %\parseargdef\need{\par %
746 %% This method tries to make TeX break the page naturally
747 %% if the depth of the box does not fit.
748 %{\baselineskip=0pt%
749 %\vtop to #1\mil{\vfil}\kern -#1\mil\nobreak
750 %\prevdepth=-1000pt
751 %}}
752
753 \parseargdef\need{%
754 % Ensure vertical mode, so we don't make a big box in the middle of a
755 % paragraph.
756 \par
757 %
758 % If the @need value is less than one line space, it's useless.
759 \dimen0 = #1\mil
760 \dimen2 = \ht\strutbox
761 \advance\dimen2 by \dp\strutbox
762 \ifdim\dimen0 > \dimen2
763 %
764 % Do a \strut just to make the height of this box be normal, so the
765 % normal leading is inserted relative to the preceding line.
766 % And a page break here is fine.
767 \vtop to #1\mil{\strut\vfil}%
768 %
769 % TeX does not even consider page breaks if a penalty added to the
770 % main vertical list is 10000 or more. But in order to see if the
771 % empty box we just added fits on the page, we must make it consider
772 % page breaks. On the other hand, we don't want to actually break the
773 % page after the empty box. So we use a penalty of 9999.
774 %
775 % There is an extremely small chance that TeX will actually break the
776 % page at this \penalty, if there are no other feasible breakpoints in
777 % sight. (If the user is using lots of big @group commands, which
778 % almost-but-not-quite fill up a page, TeX will have a hard time doing
779 % good page breaking, for example.) However, I could not construct an
780 % example where a page broke at this \penalty; if it happens in a real
781 % document, then we can reconsider our strategy.
782 \penalty9999
783 %
784 % Back up by the size of the box, whether we did a page break or not.
785 \kern -#1\mil
786 %
787 % Do not allow a page break right after this kern.
788 \nobreak
789 \fi
790 }
791
792 % @br forces paragraph break (and is undocumented).
793
794 \let\br = \par
795
796 % @page forces the start of a new page.
797 %
798 \def\page{\par\vfill\supereject}
799
800 % @exdent text....
801 % outputs text on separate line in roman font, starting at standard page margin
802
803 % This records the amount of indent in the innermost environment.
804 % That's how much \exdent should take out.
805 \newskip\exdentamount
806
807 % This defn is used inside fill environments such as @defun.
808 \parseargdef\exdent{\hfil\break\hbox{\kern -\exdentamount{\rm#1}}\hfil\break}
809
810 % This defn is used inside nofill environments such as @example.
811 \parseargdef\nofillexdent{{\advance \leftskip by -\exdentamount
812 \leftline{\hskip\leftskip{\rm#1}}}}
813
814 % @inmargin{WHICH}{TEXT} puts TEXT in the WHICH margin next to the current
815 % paragraph. For more general purposes, use the \margin insertion
816 % class. WHICH is `l' or `r'.
817 %
818 \newskip\inmarginspacing \inmarginspacing=1cm
819 \def\strutdepth{\dp\strutbox}
820 %
821 \def\doinmargin#1#2{\strut\vadjust{%
822 \nobreak
823 \kern-\strutdepth
824 \vtop to \strutdepth{%
825 \baselineskip=\strutdepth
826 \vss
827 % if you have multiple lines of stuff to put here, you'll need to
828 % make the vbox yourself of the appropriate size.
829 \ifx#1l%
830 \llap{\ignorespaces #2\hskip\inmarginspacing}%
831 \else
832 \rlap{\hskip\hsize \hskip\inmarginspacing \ignorespaces #2}%
833 \fi
834 \null
835 }%
836 }}
837 \def\inleftmargin{\doinmargin l}
838 \def\inrightmargin{\doinmargin r}
839 %
840 % @inmargin{TEXT [, RIGHT-TEXT]}
841 % (if RIGHT-TEXT is given, use TEXT for left page, RIGHT-TEXT for right;
842 % else use TEXT for both).
843 %
844 \def\inmargin#1{\parseinmargin #1,,\finish}
845 \def\parseinmargin#1,#2,#3\finish{% not perfect, but better than nothing.
846 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
847 \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt
848 \def\lefttext{#1}% have both texts
849 \def\righttext{#2}%
850 \else
851 \def\lefttext{#1}% have only one text
852 \def\righttext{#1}%
853 \fi
854 %
855 \ifodd\pageno
856 \def\temp{\inrightmargin\righttext}% odd page -> outside is right margin
857 \else
858 \def\temp{\inleftmargin\lefttext}%
859 \fi
860 \temp
861 }
862
863 % @include file insert text of that file as input.
864 %
865 \def\include{\parseargusing\filenamecatcodes\includezzz}
866 \def\includezzz#1{%
867 \pushthisfilestack
868 \def\thisfile{#1}%
869 {%
870 \makevalueexpandable
871 \def\temp{\input #1 }%
872 \expandafter
873 }\temp
874 \popthisfilestack
875 }
876 \def\filenamecatcodes{%
877 \catcode`\\=\other
878 \catcode`~=\other
879 \catcode`^=\other
880 \catcode`_=\other
881 \catcode`|=\other
882 \catcode`<=\other
883 \catcode`>=\other
884 \catcode`+=\other
885 \catcode`-=\other
886 }
887
888 \def\pushthisfilestack{%
889 \expandafter\pushthisfilestackX\popthisfilestack\StackTerm
890 }
891 \def\pushthisfilestackX{%
892 \expandafter\pushthisfilestackY\thisfile\StackTerm
893 }
894 \def\pushthisfilestackY #1\StackTerm #2\StackTerm {%
895 \gdef\popthisfilestack{\gdef\thisfile{#1}\gdef\popthisfilestack{#2}}%
896 }
897
898 \def\popthisfilestack{\errthisfilestackempty}
899 \def\errthisfilestackempty{\errmessage{Internal error:
900 the stack of filenames is empty.}}
901
902 \def\thisfile{}
903
904 % @center line
905 % outputs that line, centered.
906 %
907 \parseargdef\center{%
908 \ifhmode
909 \let\next\centerH
910 \else
911 \let\next\centerV
912 \fi
913 \next{\hfil \ignorespaces#1\unskip \hfil}%
914 }
915 \def\centerH#1{%
916 {%
917 \hfil\break
918 \advance\hsize by -\leftskip
919 \advance\hsize by -\rightskip
920 \line{#1}%
921 \break
922 }%
923 }
924 \def\centerV#1{\line{\kern\leftskip #1\kern\rightskip}}
925
926 % @sp n outputs n lines of vertical space
927
928 \parseargdef\sp{\vskip #1\baselineskip}
929
930 % @comment ...line which is ignored...
931 % @c is the same as @comment
932 % @ignore ... @end ignore is another way to write a comment
933
934 \def\comment{\begingroup \catcode`\^^M=\other%
935 \catcode`\@=\other \catcode`\{=\other \catcode`\}=\other%
936 \commentxxx}
937 {\catcode`\^^M=\other \gdef\commentxxx#1^^M{\endgroup}}
938
939 \let\c=\comment
940
941 % @paragraphindent NCHARS
942 % We'll use ems for NCHARS, close enough.
943 % NCHARS can also be the word `asis' or `none'.
944 % We cannot feasibly implement @paragraphindent asis, though.
945 %
946 \def\asisword{asis} % no translation, these are keywords
947 \def\noneword{none}
948 %
949 \parseargdef\paragraphindent{%
950 \def\temp{#1}%
951 \ifx\temp\asisword
952 \else
953 \ifx\temp\noneword
954 \defaultparindent = 0pt
955 \else
956 \defaultparindent = #1em
957 \fi
958 \fi
959 \parindent = \defaultparindent
960 }
961
962 % @exampleindent NCHARS
963 % We'll use ems for NCHARS like @paragraphindent.
964 % It seems @exampleindent asis isn't necessary, but
965 % I preserve it to make it similar to @paragraphindent.
966 \parseargdef\exampleindent{%
967 \def\temp{#1}%
968 \ifx\temp\asisword
969 \else
970 \ifx\temp\noneword
971 \lispnarrowing = 0pt
972 \else
973 \lispnarrowing = #1em
974 \fi
975 \fi
976 }
977
978 % @firstparagraphindent WORD
979 % If WORD is `none', then suppress indentation of the first paragraph
980 % after a section heading. If WORD is `insert', then do indent at such
981 % paragraphs.
982 %
983 % The paragraph indentation is suppressed or not by calling
984 % \suppressfirstparagraphindent, which the sectioning commands do.
985 % We switch the definition of this back and forth according to WORD.
986 % By default, we suppress indentation.
987 %
988 \def\suppressfirstparagraphindent{\dosuppressfirstparagraphindent}
989 \def\insertword{insert}
990 %
991 \parseargdef\firstparagraphindent{%
992 \def\temp{#1}%
993 \ifx\temp\noneword
994 \let\suppressfirstparagraphindent = \dosuppressfirstparagraphindent
995 \else\ifx\temp\insertword
996 \let\suppressfirstparagraphindent = \relax
997 \else
998 \errhelp = \EMsimple
999 \errmessage{Unknown @firstparagraphindent option `\temp'}%
1000 \fi\fi
1001 }
1002
1003 % Here is how we actually suppress indentation. Redefine \everypar to
1004 % \kern backwards by \parindent, and then reset itself to empty.
1005 %
1006 % We also make \indent itself not actually do anything until the next
1007 % paragraph.
1008 %
1009 \gdef\dosuppressfirstparagraphindent{%
1010 \gdef\indent{%
1011 \restorefirstparagraphindent
1012 \indent
1013 }%
1014 \gdef\noindent{%
1015 \restorefirstparagraphindent
1016 \noindent
1017 }%
1018 \global\everypar = {%
1019 \kern -\parindent
1020 \restorefirstparagraphindent
1021 }%
1022 }
1023
1024 \gdef\restorefirstparagraphindent{%
1025 \global \let \indent = \ptexindent
1026 \global \let \noindent = \ptexnoindent
1027 \global \everypar = {}%
1028 }
1029
1030
1031 % @asis just yields its argument. Used with @table, for example.
1032 %
1033 \def\asis#1{#1}
1034
1035 % @math outputs its argument in math mode.
1036 %
1037 % One complication: _ usually means subscripts, but it could also mean
1038 % an actual _ character, as in @math{@var{some_variable} + 1}. So make
1039 % _ active, and distinguish by seeing if the current family is \slfam,
1040 % which is what @var uses.
1041 {
1042 \catcode`\_ = \active
1043 \gdef\mathunderscore{%
1044 \catcode`\_=\active
1045 \def_{\ifnum\fam=\slfam \_\else\sb\fi}%
1046 }
1047 }
1048 % Another complication: we want \\ (and @\) to output a \ character.
1049 % FYI, plain.tex uses \\ as a temporary control sequence (why?), but
1050 % this is not advertised and we don't care. Texinfo does not
1051 % otherwise define @\.
1052 %
1053 % The \mathchar is class=0=ordinary, family=7=ttfam, position=5C=\.
1054 \def\mathbackslash{\ifnum\fam=\ttfam \mathchar"075C \else\backslash \fi}
1055 %
1056 \def\math{%
1057 \tex
1058 \mathunderscore
1059 \let\\ = \mathbackslash
1060 \mathactive
1061 $\finishmath
1062 }
1063 \def\finishmath#1{#1$\endgroup} % Close the group opened by \tex.
1064
1065 % Some active characters (such as <) are spaced differently in math.
1066 % We have to reset their definitions in case the @math was an argument
1067 % to a command which sets the catcodes (such as @item or @section).
1068 %
1069 {
1070 \catcode`^ = \active
1071 \catcode`< = \active
1072 \catcode`> = \active
1073 \catcode`+ = \active
1074 \gdef\mathactive{%
1075 \let^ = \ptexhat
1076 \let< = \ptexless
1077 \let> = \ptexgtr
1078 \let+ = \ptexplus
1079 }
1080 }
1081
1082 % @bullet and @minus need the same treatment as @math, just above.
1083 \def\bullet{$\ptexbullet$}
1084 \def\minus{$-$}
1085
1086 % @dots{} outputs an ellipsis using the current font.
1087 % We do .5em per period so that it has the same spacing in a typewriter
1088 % font as three actual period characters.
1089 %
1090 \def\dots{%
1091 \leavevmode
1092 \hbox to 1.5em{%
1093 \hskip 0pt plus 0.25fil
1094 .\hfil.\hfil.%
1095 \hskip 0pt plus 0.5fil
1096 }%
1097 }
1098
1099 % @enddots{} is an end-of-sentence ellipsis.
1100 %
1101 \def\enddots{%
1102 \dots
1103 \spacefactor=\endofsentencespacefactor
1104 }
1105
1106 % @comma{} is so commas can be inserted into text without messing up
1107 % Texinfo's parsing.
1108 %
1109 \let\comma = ,
1110
1111 % @refill is a no-op.
1112 \let\refill=\relax
1113
1114 % If working on a large document in chapters, it is convenient to
1115 % be able to disable indexing, cross-referencing, and contents, for test runs.
1116 % This is done with @novalidate (before @setfilename).
1117 %
1118 \newif\iflinks \linkstrue % by default we want the aux files.
1119 \let\novalidate = \linksfalse
1120
1121 % @setfilename is done at the beginning of every texinfo file.
1122 % So open here the files we need to have open while reading the input.
1123 % This makes it possible to make a .fmt file for texinfo.
1124 \def\setfilename{%
1125 \fixbackslash % Turn off hack to swallow `\input texinfo'.
1126 \iflinks
1127 \tryauxfile
1128 % Open the new aux file. TeX will close it automatically at exit.
1129 \immediate\openout\auxfile=\jobname.aux
1130 \fi % \openindices needs to do some work in any case.
1131 \openindices
1132 \let\setfilename=\comment % Ignore extra @setfilename cmds.
1133 %
1134 % If texinfo.cnf is present on the system, read it.
1135 % Useful for site-wide @afourpaper, etc.
1136 \openin 1 texinfo.cnf
1137 \ifeof 1 \else \input texinfo.cnf \fi
1138 \closein 1
1139 %
1140 \comment % Ignore the actual filename.
1141 }
1142
1143 % Called from \setfilename.
1144 %
1145 \def\openindices{%
1146 \newindex{cp}%
1147 \newcodeindex{fn}%
1148 \newcodeindex{vr}%
1149 \newcodeindex{tp}%
1150 \newcodeindex{ky}%
1151 \newcodeindex{pg}%
1152 }
1153
1154 % @bye.
1155 \outer\def\bye{\pagealignmacro\tracingstats=1\ptexend}
1156
1157
1158 \message{pdf,}
1159 % adobe `portable' document format
1160 \newcount\tempnum
1161 \newcount\lnkcount
1162 \newtoks\filename
1163 \newcount\filenamelength
1164 \newcount\pgn
1165 \newtoks\toksA
1166 \newtoks\toksB
1167 \newtoks\toksC
1168 \newtoks\toksD
1169 \newbox\boxA
1170 \newcount\countA
1171 \newif\ifpdf
1172 \newif\ifpdfmakepagedest
1173
1174 % when pdftex is run in dvi mode, \pdfoutput is defined (so \pdfoutput=1
1175 % can be set). So we test for \relax and 0 as well as \undefined,
1176 % borrowed from ifpdf.sty.
1177 \ifx\pdfoutput\undefined
1178 \else
1179 \ifx\pdfoutput\relax
1180 \else
1181 \ifcase\pdfoutput
1182 \else
1183 \pdftrue
1184 \fi
1185 \fi
1186 \fi
1187
1188 % PDF uses PostScript string constants for the names of xref targets,
1189 % for display in the outlines, and in other places. Thus, we have to
1190 % double any backslashes. Otherwise, a name like "\node" will be
1191 % interpreted as a newline (\n), followed by o, d, e. Not good.
1192 % http://www.ntg.nl/pipermail/ntg-pdftex/2004-July/000654.html
1193 % (and related messages, the final outcome is that it is up to the TeX
1194 % user to double the backslashes and otherwise make the string valid, so
1195 % that's what we do).
1196
1197 % double active backslashes.
1198 %
1199 {\catcode`\@=0 \catcode`\\=\active
1200 @gdef@activebackslashdouble{%
1201 @catcode`@\=@active
1202 @let\=@doublebackslash}
1203 }
1204
1205 % To handle parens, we must adopt a different approach, since parens are
1206 % not active characters. hyperref.dtx (which has the same problem as
1207 % us) handles it with this amazing macro to replace tokens. I've
1208 % tinkered with it a little for texinfo, but it's definitely from there.
1209 %
1210 % #1 is the tokens to replace.
1211 % #2 is the replacement.
1212 % #3 is the control sequence with the string.
1213 %
1214 \def\HyPsdSubst#1#2#3{%
1215 \def\HyPsdReplace##1#1##2\END{%
1216 ##1%
1217 \ifx\\##2\\%
1218 \else
1219 #2%
1220 \HyReturnAfterFi{%
1221 \HyPsdReplace##2\END
1222 }%
1223 \fi
1224 }%
1225 \xdef#3{\expandafter\HyPsdReplace#3#1\END}%
1226 }
1227 \long\def\HyReturnAfterFi#1\fi{\fi#1}
1228
1229 % #1 is a control sequence in which to do the replacements.
1230 \def\backslashparens#1{%
1231 \xdef#1{#1}% redefine it as its expansion; the definition is simply
1232 % \lastnode when called from \setref -> \pdfmkdest.
1233 \HyPsdSubst{(}{\realbackslash(}{#1}%
1234 \HyPsdSubst{)}{\realbackslash)}{#1}%
1235 }
1236
1237 \ifpdf
1238 \input pdfcolor
1239 \pdfcatalog{/PageMode /UseOutlines}%
1240 \def\dopdfimage#1#2#3{%
1241 \def\imagewidth{#2}%
1242 \def\imageheight{#3}%
1243 % without \immediate, pdftex seg faults when the same image is
1244 % included twice. (Version 3.14159-pre-1.0-unofficial-20010704.)
1245 \ifnum\pdftexversion < 14
1246 \immediate\pdfimage
1247 \else
1248 \immediate\pdfximage
1249 \fi
1250 \ifx\empty\imagewidth\else width \imagewidth \fi
1251 \ifx\empty\imageheight\else height \imageheight \fi
1252 \ifnum\pdftexversion<13
1253 #1.pdf%
1254 \else
1255 {#1.pdf}%
1256 \fi
1257 \ifnum\pdftexversion < 14 \else
1258 \pdfrefximage \pdflastximage
1259 \fi}
1260 \def\pdfmkdest#1{{%
1261 % We have to set dummies so commands such as @code, and characters
1262 % such as \, aren't expanded when present in a section title.
1263 \atdummies
1264 \activebackslashdouble
1265 \def\pdfdestname{#1}%
1266 \backslashparens\pdfdestname
1267 \pdfdest name{\pdfdestname} xyz%
1268 }}%
1269 %
1270 % used to mark target names; must be expandable.
1271 \def\pdfmkpgn#1{#1}%
1272 %
1273 \let\linkcolor = \Blue % was Cyan, but that seems light?
1274 \def\endlink{\Black\pdfendlink}
1275 % Adding outlines to PDF; macros for calculating structure of outlines
1276 % come from Petr Olsak
1277 \def\expnumber#1{\expandafter\ifx\csname#1\endcsname\relax 0%
1278 \else \csname#1\endcsname \fi}
1279 \def\advancenumber#1{\tempnum=\expnumber{#1}\relax
1280 \advance\tempnum by 1
1281 \expandafter\xdef\csname#1\endcsname{\the\tempnum}}
1282 %
1283 % #1 is the section text, which is what will be displayed in the
1284 % outline by the pdf viewer. #2 is the pdf expression for the number
1285 % of subentries (or empty, for subsubsections). #3 is the node text,
1286 % which might be empty if this toc entry had no corresponding node.
1287 % #4 is the page number
1288 %
1289 \def\dopdfoutline#1#2#3#4{%
1290 % Generate a link to the node text if that exists; else, use the
1291 % page number. We could generate a destination for the section
1292 % text in the case where a section has no node, but it doesn't
1293 % seem worth the trouble, since most documents are normally structured.
1294 \def\pdfoutlinedest{#3}%
1295 \ifx\pdfoutlinedest\empty
1296 \def\pdfoutlinedest{#4}%
1297 \else
1298 % Doubled backslashes in the name.
1299 {\activebackslashdouble \xdef\pdfoutlinedest{#3}%
1300 \backslashparens\pdfoutlinedest}%
1301 \fi
1302 %
1303 % Also double the backslashes in the display string.
1304 {\activebackslashdouble \xdef\pdfoutlinetext{#1}%
1305 \backslashparens\pdfoutlinetext}%
1306 %
1307 \pdfoutline goto name{\pdfmkpgn{\pdfoutlinedest}}#2{\pdfoutlinetext}%
1308 }
1309 %
1310 \def\pdfmakeoutlines{%
1311 \begingroup
1312 % Thanh's hack / proper braces in bookmarks
1313 \edef\mylbrace{\iftrue \string{\else}\fi}\let\{=\mylbrace
1314 \edef\myrbrace{\iffalse{\else\string}\fi}\let\}=\myrbrace
1315 %
1316 % Read toc silently, to get counts of subentries for \pdfoutline.
1317 \def\numchapentry##1##2##3##4{%
1318 \def\thischapnum{##2}%
1319 \def\thissecnum{0}%
1320 \def\thissubsecnum{0}%
1321 }%
1322 \def\numsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
1323 \advancenumber{chap\thischapnum}%
1324 \def\thissecnum{##2}%
1325 \def\thissubsecnum{0}%
1326 }%
1327 \def\numsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
1328 \advancenumber{sec\thissecnum}%
1329 \def\thissubsecnum{##2}%
1330 }%
1331 \def\numsubsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
1332 \advancenumber{subsec\thissubsecnum}%
1333 }%
1334 \def\thischapnum{0}%
1335 \def\thissecnum{0}%
1336 \def\thissubsecnum{0}%
1337 %
1338 % use \def rather than \let here because we redefine \chapentry et
1339 % al. a second time, below.
1340 \def\appentry{\numchapentry}%
1341 \def\appsecentry{\numsecentry}%
1342 \def\appsubsecentry{\numsubsecentry}%
1343 \def\appsubsubsecentry{\numsubsubsecentry}%
1344 \def\unnchapentry{\numchapentry}%
1345 \def\unnsecentry{\numsecentry}%
1346 \def\unnsubsecentry{\numsubsecentry}%
1347 \def\unnsubsubsecentry{\numsubsubsecentry}%
1348 \readdatafile{toc}%
1349 %
1350 % Read toc second time, this time actually producing the outlines.
1351 % The `-' means take the \expnumber as the absolute number of
1352 % subentries, which we calculated on our first read of the .toc above.
1353 %
1354 % We use the node names as the destinations.
1355 \def\numchapentry##1##2##3##4{%
1356 \dopdfoutline{##1}{count-\expnumber{chap##2}}{##3}{##4}}%
1357 \def\numsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
1358 \dopdfoutline{##1}{count-\expnumber{sec##2}}{##3}{##4}}%
1359 \def\numsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
1360 \dopdfoutline{##1}{count-\expnumber{subsec##2}}{##3}{##4}}%
1361 \def\numsubsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{% count is always zero
1362 \dopdfoutline{##1}{}{##3}{##4}}%
1363 %
1364 % PDF outlines are displayed using system fonts, instead of
1365 % document fonts. Therefore we cannot use special characters,
1366 % since the encoding is unknown. For example, the eogonek from
1367 % Latin 2 (0xea) gets translated to a | character. Info from
1368 % Staszek Wawrykiewicz, 19 Jan 2004 04:09:24 +0100.
1369 %
1370 % xx to do this right, we have to translate 8-bit characters to
1371 % their "best" equivalent, based on the @documentencoding. Right
1372 % now, I guess we'll just let the pdf reader have its way.
1373 \indexnofonts
1374 \setupdatafile
1375 \catcode`\\=\active \otherbackslash
1376 \input \jobname.toc
1377 \endgroup
1378 }
1379 %
1380 \def\skipspaces#1{\def\PP{#1}\def\D{|}%
1381 \ifx\PP\D\let\nextsp\relax
1382 \else\let\nextsp\skipspaces
1383 \ifx\p\space\else\addtokens{\filename}{\PP}%
1384 \advance\filenamelength by 1
1385 \fi
1386 \fi
1387 \nextsp}
1388 \def\getfilename#1{\filenamelength=0\expandafter\skipspaces#1|\relax}
1389 \ifnum\pdftexversion < 14
1390 \let \startlink \pdfannotlink
1391 \else
1392 \let \startlink \pdfstartlink
1393 \fi
1394 % make a live url in pdf output.
1395 \def\pdfurl#1{%
1396 \begingroup
1397 % it seems we really need yet another set of dummies; have not
1398 % tried to figure out what each command should do in the context
1399 % of @url. for now, just make @/ a no-op, that's the only one
1400 % people have actually reported a problem with.
1401 %
1402 \normalturnoffactive
1403 \def\@{@}%
1404 \let\/=\empty
1405 \makevalueexpandable
1406 \leavevmode\Red
1407 \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]}%
1408 user{/Subtype /Link /A << /S /URI /URI (#1) >>}%
1409 \endgroup}
1410 \def\pdfgettoks#1.{\setbox\boxA=\hbox{\toksA={#1.}\toksB={}\maketoks}}
1411 \def\addtokens#1#2{\edef\addtoks{\noexpand#1={\the#1#2}}\addtoks}
1412 \def\adn#1{\addtokens{\toksC}{#1}\global\countA=1\let\next=\maketoks}
1413 \def\poptoks#1#2|ENDTOKS|{\let\first=#1\toksD={#1}\toksA={#2}}
1414 \def\maketoks{%
1415 \expandafter\poptoks\the\toksA|ENDTOKS|\relax
1416 \ifx\first0\adn0
1417 \else\ifx\first1\adn1 \else\ifx\first2\adn2 \else\ifx\first3\adn3
1418 \else\ifx\first4\adn4 \else\ifx\first5\adn5 \else\ifx\first6\adn6
1419 \else\ifx\first7\adn7 \else\ifx\first8\adn8 \else\ifx\first9\adn9
1420 \else
1421 \ifnum0=\countA\else\makelink\fi
1422 \ifx\first.\let\next=\done\else
1423 \let\next=\maketoks
1424 \addtokens{\toksB}{\the\toksD}
1425 \ifx\first,\addtokens{\toksB}{\space}\fi
1426 \fi
1427 \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi
1428 \next}
1429 \def\makelink{\addtokens{\toksB}%
1430 {\noexpand\pdflink{\the\toksC}}\toksC={}\global\countA=0}
1431 \def\pdflink#1{%
1432 \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]} goto name{\pdfmkpgn{#1}}
1433 \linkcolor #1\endlink}
1434 \def\done{\edef\st{\global\noexpand\toksA={\the\toksB}}\st}
1435 \else
1436 \let\pdfmkdest = \gobble
1437 \let\pdfurl = \gobble
1438 \let\endlink = \relax
1439 \let\linkcolor = \relax
1440 \let\pdfmakeoutlines = \relax
1441 \fi % \ifx\pdfoutput
1442
1443
1444 \message{fonts,}
1445
1446 % Change the current font style to #1, remembering it in \curfontstyle.
1447 % For now, we do not accumulate font styles: @b{@i{foo}} prints foo in
1448 % italics, not bold italics.
1449 %
1450 \def\setfontstyle#1{%
1451 \def\curfontstyle{#1}% not as a control sequence, because we are \edef'd.
1452 \csname ten#1\endcsname % change the current font
1453 }
1454
1455 % Select #1 fonts with the current style.
1456 %
1457 \def\selectfonts#1{\csname #1fonts\endcsname \csname\curfontstyle\endcsname}
1458
1459 \def\rm{\fam=0 \setfontstyle{rm}}
1460 \def\it{\fam=\itfam \setfontstyle{it}}
1461 \def\sl{\fam=\slfam \setfontstyle{sl}}
1462 \def\bf{\fam=\bffam \setfontstyle{bf}}\def\bfstylename{bf}
1463 \def\tt{\fam=\ttfam \setfontstyle{tt}}
1464
1465 % Texinfo sort of supports the sans serif font style, which plain TeX does not.
1466 % So we set up a \sf.
1467 \newfam\sffam
1468 \def\sf{\fam=\sffam \setfontstyle{sf}}
1469 \let\li = \sf % Sometimes we call it \li, not \sf.
1470
1471 % We don't need math for this font style.
1472 \def\ttsl{\setfontstyle{ttsl}}
1473
1474 % Default leading.
1475 \newdimen\textleading \textleading = 13.2pt
1476
1477 % Set the baselineskip to #1, and the lineskip and strut size
1478 % correspondingly. There is no deep meaning behind these magic numbers
1479 % used as factors; they just match (closely enough) what Knuth defined.
1480 %
1481 \def\lineskipfactor{.08333}
1482 \def\strutheightpercent{.70833}
1483 \def\strutdepthpercent {.29167}
1484 %
1485 \def\setleading#1{%
1486 \normalbaselineskip = #1\relax
1487 \normallineskip = \lineskipfactor\normalbaselineskip
1488 \normalbaselines
1489 \setbox\strutbox =\hbox{%
1490 \vrule width0pt height\strutheightpercent\baselineskip
1491 depth \strutdepthpercent \baselineskip
1492 }%
1493 }
1494
1495 % Set the font macro #1 to the font named #2, adding on the
1496 % specified font prefix (normally `cm').
1497 % #3 is the font's design size, #4 is a scale factor
1498 \def\setfont#1#2#3#4{\font#1=\fontprefix#2#3 scaled #4}
1499
1500 % Use cm as the default font prefix.
1501 % To specify the font prefix, you must define \fontprefix
1502 % before you read in texinfo.tex.
1503 \ifx\fontprefix\undefined
1504 \def\fontprefix{cm}
1505 \fi
1506 % Support font families that don't use the same naming scheme as CM.
1507 \def\rmshape{r}
1508 \def\rmbshape{bx} %where the normal face is bold
1509 \def\bfshape{b}
1510 \def\bxshape{bx}
1511 \def\ttshape{tt}
1512 \def\ttbshape{tt}
1513 \def\ttslshape{sltt}
1514 \def\itshape{ti}
1515 \def\itbshape{bxti}
1516 \def\slshape{sl}
1517 \def\slbshape{bxsl}
1518 \def\sfshape{ss}
1519 \def\sfbshape{ss}
1520 \def\scshape{csc}
1521 \def\scbshape{csc}
1522
1523 % Text fonts (11.2pt, magstep1).
1524 \def\textnominalsize{11pt}
1525 \edef\mainmagstep{\magstephalf}
1526 \setfont\textrm\rmshape{10}{\mainmagstep}
1527 \setfont\texttt\ttshape{10}{\mainmagstep}
1528 \setfont\textbf\bfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}
1529 \setfont\textit\itshape{10}{\mainmagstep}
1530 \setfont\textsl\slshape{10}{\mainmagstep}
1531 \setfont\textsf\sfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}
1532 \setfont\textsc\scshape{10}{\mainmagstep}
1533 \setfont\textttsl\ttslshape{10}{\mainmagstep}
1534 \font\texti=cmmi10 scaled \mainmagstep
1535 \font\textsy=cmsy10 scaled \mainmagstep
1536
1537 % A few fonts for @defun names and args.
1538 \setfont\defbf\bfshape{10}{\magstep1}
1539 \setfont\deftt\ttshape{10}{\magstep1}
1540 \setfont\defttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep1}
1541 \def\df{\let\tentt=\deftt \let\tenbf = \defbf \let\tenttsl=\defttsl \bf}
1542
1543 % Fonts for indices, footnotes, small examples (9pt).
1544 \def\smallnominalsize{9pt}
1545 \setfont\smallrm\rmshape{9}{1000}
1546 \setfont\smalltt\ttshape{9}{1000}
1547 \setfont\smallbf\bfshape{10}{900}
1548 \setfont\smallit\itshape{9}{1000}
1549 \setfont\smallsl\slshape{9}{1000}
1550 \setfont\smallsf\sfshape{9}{1000}
1551 \setfont\smallsc\scshape{10}{900}
1552 \setfont\smallttsl\ttslshape{10}{900}
1553 \font\smalli=cmmi9
1554 \font\smallsy=cmsy9
1555
1556 % Fonts for small examples (8pt).
1557 \def\smallernominalsize{8pt}
1558 \setfont\smallerrm\rmshape{8}{1000}
1559 \setfont\smallertt\ttshape{8}{1000}
1560 \setfont\smallerbf\bfshape{10}{800}
1561 \setfont\smallerit\itshape{8}{1000}
1562 \setfont\smallersl\slshape{8}{1000}
1563 \setfont\smallersf\sfshape{8}{1000}
1564 \setfont\smallersc\scshape{10}{800}
1565 \setfont\smallerttsl\ttslshape{10}{800}
1566 \font\smalleri=cmmi8
1567 \font\smallersy=cmsy8
1568
1569 % Fonts for title page (20.4pt):
1570 \def\titlenominalsize{20pt}
1571 \setfont\titlerm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep3}
1572 \setfont\titleit\itbshape{10}{\magstep4}
1573 \setfont\titlesl\slbshape{10}{\magstep4}
1574 \setfont\titlett\ttbshape{12}{\magstep3}
1575 \setfont\titlettsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep4}
1576 \setfont\titlesf\sfbshape{17}{\magstep1}
1577 \let\titlebf=\titlerm
1578 \setfont\titlesc\scbshape{10}{\magstep4}
1579 \font\titlei=cmmi12 scaled \magstep3
1580 \font\titlesy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep4
1581 \def\authorrm{\secrm}
1582 \def\authortt{\sectt}
1583
1584 % Chapter (and unnumbered) fonts (17.28pt).
1585 \def\chapnominalsize{17pt}
1586 \setfont\chaprm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep2}
1587 \setfont\chapit\itbshape{10}{\magstep3}
1588 \setfont\chapsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep3}
1589 \setfont\chaptt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep2}
1590 \setfont\chapttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep3}
1591 \setfont\chapsf\sfbshape{17}{1000}
1592 \let\chapbf=\chaprm
1593 \setfont\chapsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep3}
1594 \font\chapi=cmmi12 scaled \magstep2
1595 \font\chapsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep3
1596
1597 % Section fonts (14.4pt).
1598 \def\secnominalsize{14pt}
1599 \setfont\secrm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep1}
1600 \setfont\secit\itbshape{10}{\magstep2}
1601 \setfont\secsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep2}
1602 \setfont\sectt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep1}
1603 \setfont\secttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep2}
1604 \setfont\secsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstep1}
1605 \let\secbf\secrm
1606 \setfont\secsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep2}
1607 \font\seci=cmmi12 scaled \magstep1
1608 \font\secsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep2
1609
1610 % Subsection fonts (13.15pt).
1611 \def\ssecnominalsize{13pt}
1612 \setfont\ssecrm\rmbshape{12}{\magstephalf}
1613 \setfont\ssecit\itbshape{10}{1315}
1614 \setfont\ssecsl\slbshape{10}{1315}
1615 \setfont\ssectt\ttbshape{12}{\magstephalf}
1616 \setfont\ssecttsl\ttslshape{10}{1315}
1617 \setfont\ssecsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstephalf}
1618 \let\ssecbf\ssecrm
1619 \setfont\ssecsc\scbshape{10}{1315}
1620 \font\sseci=cmmi12 scaled \magstephalf
1621 \font\ssecsy=cmsy10 scaled 1315
1622
1623 % Reduced fonts for @acro in text (10pt).
1624 \def\reducednominalsize{10pt}
1625 \setfont\reducedrm\rmshape{10}{1000}
1626 \setfont\reducedtt\ttshape{10}{1000}
1627 \setfont\reducedbf\bfshape{10}{1000}
1628 \setfont\reducedit\itshape{10}{1000}
1629 \setfont\reducedsl\slshape{10}{1000}
1630 \setfont\reducedsf\sfshape{10}{1000}
1631 \setfont\reducedsc\scshape{10}{1000}
1632 \setfont\reducedttsl\ttslshape{10}{1000}
1633 \font\reducedi=cmmi10
1634 \font\reducedsy=cmsy10
1635
1636 % In order for the font changes to affect most math symbols and letters,
1637 % we have to define the \textfont of the standard families. Since
1638 % texinfo doesn't allow for producing subscripts and superscripts except
1639 % in the main text, we don't bother to reset \scriptfont and
1640 % \scriptscriptfont (which would also require loading a lot more fonts).
1641 %
1642 \def\resetmathfonts{%
1643 \textfont0=\tenrm \textfont1=\teni \textfont2=\tensy
1644 \textfont\itfam=\tenit \textfont\slfam=\tensl \textfont\bffam=\tenbf
1645 \textfont\ttfam=\tentt \textfont\sffam=\tensf
1646 }
1647
1648 % The font-changing commands redefine the meanings of \tenSTYLE, instead
1649 % of just \STYLE. We do this because \STYLE needs to also set the
1650 % current \fam for math mode. Our \STYLE (e.g., \rm) commands hardwire
1651 % \tenSTYLE to set the current font.
1652 %
1653 % Each font-changing command also sets the names \lsize (one size lower)
1654 % and \lllsize (three sizes lower). These relative commands are used in
1655 % the LaTeX logo and acronyms.
1656 %
1657 % This all needs generalizing, badly.
1658 %
1659 \def\textfonts{%
1660 \let\tenrm=\textrm \let\tenit=\textit \let\tensl=\textsl
1661 \let\tenbf=\textbf \let\tentt=\texttt \let\smallcaps=\textsc
1662 \let\tensf=\textsf \let\teni=\texti \let\tensy=\textsy
1663 \let\tenttsl=\textttsl
1664 \def\curfontsize{text}%
1665 \def\lsize{reduced}\def\lllsize{smaller}%
1666 \resetmathfonts \setleading{\textleading}}
1667 \def\titlefonts{%
1668 \let\tenrm=\titlerm \let\tenit=\titleit \let\tensl=\titlesl
1669 \let\tenbf=\titlebf \let\tentt=\titlett \let\smallcaps=\titlesc
1670 \let\tensf=\titlesf \let\teni=\titlei \let\tensy=\titlesy
1671 \let\tenttsl=\titlettsl
1672 \def\curfontsize{title}%
1673 \def\lsize{chap}\def\lllsize{subsec}%
1674 \resetmathfonts \setleading{25pt}}
1675 \def\titlefont#1{{\titlefonts\rm #1}}
1676 \def\chapfonts{%
1677 \let\tenrm=\chaprm \let\tenit=\chapit \let\tensl=\chapsl
1678 \let\tenbf=\chapbf \let\tentt=\chaptt \let\smallcaps=\chapsc
1679 \let\tensf=\chapsf \let\teni=\chapi \let\tensy=\chapsy
1680 \let\tenttsl=\chapttsl
1681 \def\curfontsize{chap}%
1682 \def\lsize{sec}\def\lllsize{text}%
1683 \resetmathfonts \setleading{19pt}}
1684 \def\secfonts{%
1685 \let\tenrm=\secrm \let\tenit=\secit \let\tensl=\secsl
1686 \let\tenbf=\secbf \let\tentt=\sectt \let\smallcaps=\secsc
1687 \let\tensf=\secsf \let\teni=\seci \let\tensy=\secsy
1688 \let\tenttsl=\secttsl
1689 \def\curfontsize{sec}%
1690 \def\lsize{subsec}\def\lllsize{reduced}%
1691 \resetmathfonts \setleading{16pt}}
1692 \def\subsecfonts{%
1693 \let\tenrm=\ssecrm \let\tenit=\ssecit \let\tensl=\ssecsl
1694 \let\tenbf=\ssecbf \let\tentt=\ssectt \let\smallcaps=\ssecsc
1695 \let\tensf=\ssecsf \let\teni=\sseci \let\tensy=\ssecsy
1696 \let\tenttsl=\ssecttsl
1697 \def\curfontsize{ssec}%
1698 \def\lsize{text}\def\lllsize{small}%
1699 \resetmathfonts \setleading{15pt}}
1700 \let\subsubsecfonts = \subsecfonts
1701 \def\reducedfonts{%
1702 \let\tenrm=\reducedrm \let\tenit=\reducedit \let\tensl=\reducedsl
1703 \let\tenbf=\reducedbf \let\tentt=\reducedtt \let\reducedcaps=\reducedsc
1704 \let\tensf=\reducedsf \let\teni=\reducedi \let\tensy=\reducedsy
1705 \let\tenttsl=\reducedttsl
1706 \def\curfontsize{reduced}%
1707 \def\lsize{small}\def\lllsize{smaller}%
1708 \resetmathfonts \setleading{10.5pt}}
1709 \def\smallfonts{%
1710 \let\tenrm=\smallrm \let\tenit=\smallit \let\tensl=\smallsl
1711 \let\tenbf=\smallbf \let\tentt=\smalltt \let\smallcaps=\smallsc
1712 \let\tensf=\smallsf \let\teni=\smalli \let\tensy=\smallsy
1713 \let\tenttsl=\smallttsl
1714 \def\curfontsize{small}%
1715 \def\lsize{smaller}\def\lllsize{smaller}%
1716 \resetmathfonts \setleading{10.5pt}}
1717 \def\smallerfonts{%
1718 \let\tenrm=\smallerrm \let\tenit=\smallerit \let\tensl=\smallersl
1719 \let\tenbf=\smallerbf \let\tentt=\smallertt \let\smallcaps=\smallersc
1720 \let\tensf=\smallersf \let\teni=\smalleri \let\tensy=\smallersy
1721 \let\tenttsl=\smallerttsl
1722 \def\curfontsize{smaller}%
1723 \def\lsize{smaller}\def\lllsize{smaller}%
1724 \resetmathfonts \setleading{9.5pt}}
1725
1726 % Set the fonts to use with the @small... environments.
1727 \let\smallexamplefonts = \smallfonts
1728
1729 % About \smallexamplefonts. If we use \smallfonts (9pt), @smallexample
1730 % can fit this many characters:
1731 % 8.5x11=86 smallbook=72 a4=90 a5=69
1732 % If we use \scriptfonts (8pt), then we can fit this many characters:
1733 % 8.5x11=90+ smallbook=80 a4=90+ a5=77
1734 % For me, subjectively, the few extra characters that fit aren't worth
1735 % the additional smallness of 8pt. So I'm making the default 9pt.
1736 %
1737 % By the way, for comparison, here's what fits with @example (10pt):
1738 % 8.5x11=71 smallbook=60 a4=75 a5=58
1739 %
1740 % I wish the USA used A4 paper.
1741 % --karl, 24jan03.
1742
1743
1744 % Set up the default fonts, so we can use them for creating boxes.
1745 %
1746 \textfonts \rm
1747
1748 % Define these so they can be easily changed for other fonts.
1749 \def\angleleft{$\langle$}
1750 \def\angleright{$\rangle$}
1751
1752 % Count depth in font-changes, for error checks
1753 \newcount\fontdepth \fontdepth=0
1754
1755 % Fonts for short table of contents.
1756 \setfont\shortcontrm\rmshape{12}{1000}
1757 \setfont\shortcontbf\bfshape{10}{\magstep1} % no cmb12
1758 \setfont\shortcontsl\slshape{12}{1000}
1759 \setfont\shortconttt\ttshape{12}{1000}
1760
1761 %% Add scribe-like font environments, plus @l for inline lisp (usually sans
1762 %% serif) and @ii for TeX italic
1763
1764 % \smartitalic{ARG} outputs arg in italics, followed by an italic correction
1765 % unless the following character is such as not to need one.
1766 \def\smartitalicx{\ifx\next,\else\ifx\next-\else\ifx\next.\else
1767 \ptexslash\fi\fi\fi}
1768 \def\smartslanted#1{{\ifusingtt\ttsl\sl #1}\futurelet\next\smartitalicx}
1769 \def\smartitalic#1{{\ifusingtt\ttsl\it #1}\futurelet\next\smartitalicx}
1770
1771 % like \smartslanted except unconditionally uses \ttsl.
1772 % @var is set to this for defun arguments.
1773 \def\ttslanted#1{{\ttsl #1}\futurelet\next\smartitalicx}
1774
1775 % like \smartslanted except unconditionally use \sl. We never want
1776 % ttsl for book titles, do we?
1777 \def\cite#1{{\sl #1}\futurelet\next\smartitalicx}
1778
1779 \let\i=\smartitalic
1780 \let\slanted=\smartslanted
1781 \let\var=\smartslanted
1782 \let\dfn=\smartslanted
1783 \let\emph=\smartitalic
1784
1785 % @b, explicit bold.
1786 \def\b#1{{\bf #1}}
1787 \let\strong=\b
1788
1789 % @sansserif, explicit sans.
1790 \def\sansserif#1{{\sf #1}}
1791
1792 % We can't just use \exhyphenpenalty, because that only has effect at
1793 % the end of a paragraph. Restore normal hyphenation at the end of the
1794 % group within which \nohyphenation is presumably called.
1795 %
1796 \def\nohyphenation{\hyphenchar\font = -1 \aftergroup\restorehyphenation}
1797 \def\restorehyphenation{\hyphenchar\font = `- }
1798
1799 % Set sfcode to normal for the chars that usually have another value.
1800 % Can't use plain's \frenchspacing because it uses the `\x notation, and
1801 % sometimes \x has an active definition that messes things up.
1802 %
1803 \chardef\colonChar = `\:
1804 \chardef\commaChar = `\,
1805 \chardef\dotChar = `\.
1806 \chardef\exclamChar= `\!
1807 \chardef\questChar = `\?
1808 \chardef\semiChar = `\;
1809 %
1810 \catcode`@=11
1811 \def\plainfrenchspacing{%
1812 \sfcode\dotChar =\@m \sfcode\questChar=\@m \sfcode\exclamChar=\@m
1813 \sfcode\colonChar=\@m \sfcode\semiChar =\@m \sfcode\commaChar =\@m
1814 \def\endofsentencespacefactor{1000}% for @. and friends
1815 }
1816 \def\plainnonfrenchspacing{%
1817 \sfcode`\.3000\sfcode`\?3000\sfcode`\!3000
1818 \sfcode`\:2000\sfcode`\;1500\sfcode`\,1250
1819 \def\endofsentencespacefactor{3000}% for @. and friends
1820 }
1821 \catcode`@=\other
1822 \def\endofsentencespacefactor{3000}% default
1823
1824 \def\t#1{%
1825 {\tt \rawbackslash \plainfrenchspacing #1}%
1826 \null
1827 }
1828 \def\samp#1{`\tclose{#1}'\null}
1829 \setfont\keyrm\rmshape{8}{1000}
1830 \font\keysy=cmsy9
1831 \def\key#1{{\keyrm\textfont2=\keysy \leavevmode\hbox{%
1832 \raise0.4pt\hbox{\angleleft}\kern-.08em\vtop{%
1833 \vbox{\hrule\kern-0.4pt
1834 \hbox{\raise0.4pt\hbox{\vphantom{\angleleft}}#1}}%
1835 \kern-0.4pt\hrule}%
1836 \kern-.06em\raise0.4pt\hbox{\angleright}}}}
1837 % The old definition, with no lozenge:
1838 %\def\key #1{{\ttsl \nohyphenation \uppercase{#1}}\null}
1839 \def\ctrl #1{{\tt \rawbackslash \hat}#1}
1840
1841 % @file, @option are the same as @samp.
1842 \let\file=\samp
1843 \let\option=\samp
1844
1845 % @code is a modification of @t,
1846 % which makes spaces the same size as normal in the surrounding text.
1847 \def\tclose#1{%
1848 {%
1849 % Change normal interword space to be same as for the current font.
1850 \spaceskip = \fontdimen2\font
1851 %
1852 % Switch to typewriter.
1853 \tt
1854 %
1855 % But `\ ' produces the large typewriter interword space.
1856 \def\ {{\spaceskip = 0pt{} }}%
1857 %
1858 % Turn off hyphenation.
1859 \nohyphenation
1860 %
1861 \rawbackslash
1862 \plainfrenchspacing
1863 #1%
1864 }%
1865 \null
1866 }
1867
1868 % We *must* turn on hyphenation at `-' and `_' in @code.
1869 % Otherwise, it is too hard to avoid overfull hboxes
1870 % in the Emacs manual, the Library manual, etc.
1871
1872 % Unfortunately, TeX uses one parameter (\hyphenchar) to control
1873 % both hyphenation at - and hyphenation within words.
1874 % We must therefore turn them both off (\tclose does that)
1875 % and arrange explicitly to hyphenate at a dash.
1876 % -- rms.
1877 {
1878 \catcode`\-=\active
1879 \catcode`\_=\active
1880 %
1881 \global\def\code{\begingroup
1882 \catcode`\-=\active \catcode`\_=\active
1883 \ifallowcodebreaks
1884 \let-\codedash
1885 \let_\codeunder
1886 \else
1887 \let-\realdash
1888 \let_\realunder
1889 \fi
1890 \codex
1891 }
1892 }
1893
1894 \def\realdash{-}
1895 \def\codedash{-\discretionary{}{}{}}
1896 \def\codeunder{%
1897 % this is all so @math{@code{var_name}+1} can work. In math mode, _
1898 % is "active" (mathcode"8000) and \normalunderscore (or \char95, etc.)
1899 % will therefore expand the active definition of _, which is us
1900 % (inside @code that is), therefore an endless loop.
1901 \ifusingtt{\ifmmode
1902 \mathchar"075F % class 0=ordinary, family 7=ttfam, pos 0x5F=_.
1903 \else\normalunderscore \fi
1904 \discretionary{}{}{}}%
1905 {\_}%
1906 }
1907 \def\codex #1{\tclose{#1}\endgroup}
1908
1909 % An additional complication: the above will allow breaks after, e.g.,
1910 % each of the four underscores in __typeof__. This is undesirable in
1911 % some manuals, especially if they don't have long identifiers in
1912 % general. @allowcodebreaks provides a way to control this.
1913 %
1914 \newif\ifallowcodebreaks \allowcodebreakstrue
1915
1916 \def\keywordtrue{true}
1917 \def\keywordfalse{false}
1918
1919 \parseargdef\allowcodebreaks{%
1920 \def\txiarg{#1}%
1921 \ifx\txiarg\keywordtrue
1922 \allowcodebreakstrue
1923 \else\ifx\txiarg\keywordfalse
1924 \allowcodebreaksfalse
1925 \else
1926 \errhelp = \EMsimple
1927 \errmessage{Unknown @allowcodebreaks option `\txiarg'}%
1928 \fi\fi
1929 }
1930
1931 % @kbd is like @code, except that if the argument is just one @key command,
1932 % then @kbd has no effect.
1933
1934 % @kbdinputstyle -- arg is `distinct' (@kbd uses slanted tty font always),
1935 % `example' (@kbd uses ttsl only inside of @example and friends),
1936 % or `code' (@kbd uses normal tty font always).
1937 \parseargdef\kbdinputstyle{%
1938 \def\txiarg{#1}%
1939 \ifx\txiarg\worddistinct
1940 \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\ttsl}\gdef\kbdfont{\ttsl}%
1941 \else\ifx\txiarg\wordexample
1942 \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\ttsl}\gdef\kbdfont{\tt}%
1943 \else\ifx\txiarg\wordcode
1944 \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\tt}\gdef\kbdfont{\tt}%
1945 \else
1946 \errhelp = \EMsimple
1947 \errmessage{Unknown @kbdinputstyle option `\txiarg'}%
1948 \fi\fi\fi
1949 }
1950 \def\worddistinct{distinct}
1951 \def\wordexample{example}
1952 \def\wordcode{code}
1953
1954 % Default is `distinct.'
1955 \kbdinputstyle distinct
1956
1957 \def\xkey{\key}
1958 \def\kbdfoo#1#2#3\par{\def\one{#1}\def\three{#3}\def\threex{??}%
1959 \ifx\one\xkey\ifx\threex\three \key{#2}%
1960 \else{\tclose{\kbdfont\look}}\fi
1961 \else{\tclose{\kbdfont\look}}\fi}
1962
1963 % For @indicateurl, @env, @command quotes seem unnecessary, so use \code.
1964 \let\indicateurl=\code
1965 \let\env=\code
1966 \let\command=\code
1967
1968 % @uref (abbreviation for `urlref') takes an optional (comma-separated)
1969 % second argument specifying the text to display and an optional third
1970 % arg as text to display instead of (rather than in addition to) the url
1971 % itself. First (mandatory) arg is the url. Perhaps eventually put in
1972 % a hypertex \special here.
1973 %
1974 \def\uref#1{\douref #1,,,\finish}
1975 \def\douref#1,#2,#3,#4\finish{\begingroup
1976 \unsepspaces
1977 \pdfurl{#1}%
1978 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #3}%
1979 \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt
1980 \unhbox0 % third arg given, show only that
1981 \else
1982 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
1983 \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt
1984 \ifpdf
1985 \unhbox0 % PDF: 2nd arg given, show only it
1986 \else
1987 \unhbox0\ (\code{#1})% DVI: 2nd arg given, show both it and url
1988 \fi
1989 \else
1990 \code{#1}% only url given, so show it
1991 \fi
1992 \fi
1993 \endlink
1994 \endgroup}
1995
1996 % @url synonym for @uref, since that's how everyone uses it.
1997 %
1998 \let\url=\uref
1999
2000 % rms does not like angle brackets --karl, 17may97.
2001 % So now @email is just like @uref, unless we are pdf.
2002 %
2003 %\def\email#1{\angleleft{\tt #1}\angleright}
2004 \ifpdf
2005 \def\email#1{\doemail#1,,\finish}
2006 \def\doemail#1,#2,#3\finish{\begingroup
2007 \unsepspaces
2008 \pdfurl{mailto:#1}%
2009 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
2010 \ifdim\wd0>0pt\unhbox0\else\code{#1}\fi
2011 \endlink
2012 \endgroup}
2013 \else
2014 \let\email=\uref
2015 \fi
2016
2017 % Check if we are currently using a typewriter font. Since all the
2018 % Computer Modern typewriter fonts have zero interword stretch (and
2019 % shrink), and it is reasonable to expect all typewriter fonts to have
2020 % this property, we can check that font parameter.
2021 %
2022 \def\ifmonospace{\ifdim\fontdimen3\font=0pt }
2023
2024 % Typeset a dimension, e.g., `in' or `pt'. The only reason for the
2025 % argument is to make the input look right: @dmn{pt} instead of @dmn{}pt.
2026 %
2027 \def\dmn#1{\thinspace #1}
2028
2029 \def\kbd#1{\def\look{#1}\expandafter\kbdfoo\look??\par}
2030
2031 % @l was never documented to mean ``switch to the Lisp font'',
2032 % and it is not used as such in any manual I can find. We need it for
2033 % Polish suppressed-l. --karl, 22sep96.
2034 %\def\l#1{{\li #1}\null}
2035
2036 % Explicit font changes: @r, @sc, undocumented @ii.
2037 \def\r#1{{\rm #1}} % roman font
2038 \def\sc#1{{\smallcaps#1}} % smallcaps font
2039 \def\ii#1{{\it #1}} % italic font
2040
2041 % @acronym for "FBI", "NATO", and the like.
2042 % We print this one point size smaller, since it's intended for
2043 % all-uppercase.
2044 %
2045 \def\acronym#1{\doacronym #1,,\finish}
2046 \def\doacronym#1,#2,#3\finish{%
2047 {\selectfonts\lsize #1}%
2048 \def\temp{#2}%
2049 \ifx\temp\empty \else
2050 \space ({\unsepspaces \ignorespaces \temp \unskip})%
2051 \fi
2052 }
2053
2054 % @abbr for "Comput. J." and the like.
2055 % No font change, but don't do end-of-sentence spacing.
2056 %
2057 \def\abbr#1{\doabbr #1,,\finish}
2058 \def\doabbr#1,#2,#3\finish{%
2059 {\plainfrenchspacing #1}%
2060 \def\temp{#2}%
2061 \ifx\temp\empty \else
2062 \space ({\unsepspaces \ignorespaces \temp \unskip})%
2063 \fi
2064 }
2065
2066 % @pounds{} is a sterling sign, which Knuth put in the CM italic font.
2067 %
2068 \def\pounds{{\it\$}}
2069
2070 % @euro{} comes from a separate font, depending on the current style.
2071 % We use the free feym* fonts from the eurosym package by Henrik
2072 % Theiling, which support regular, slanted, bold and bold slanted (and
2073 % "outlined" (blackboard board, sort of) versions, which we don't need).
2074 % It is available from http://www.ctan.org/tex-archive/fonts/eurosym.
2075 %
2076 % Although only regular is the truly official Euro symbol, we ignore
2077 % that. The Euro is designed to be slightly taller than the regular
2078 % font height.
2079 %
2080 % feymr - regular
2081 % feymo - slanted
2082 % feybr - bold
2083 % feybo - bold slanted
2084 %
2085 % There is no good (free) typewriter version, to my knowledge.
2086 % A feymr10 euro is ~7.3pt wide, while a normal cmtt10 char is ~5.25pt wide.
2087 % Hmm.
2088 %
2089 % Also doesn't work in math. Do we need to do math with euro symbols?
2090 % Hope not.
2091 %
2092 %
2093 \def\euro{{\eurofont e}}
2094 \def\eurofont{%
2095 % We set the font at each command, rather than predefining it in
2096 % \textfonts and the other font-switching commands, so that
2097 % installations which never need the symbol don't have to have the
2098 % font installed.
2099 %
2100 % There is only one designed size (nominal 10pt), so we always scale
2101 % that to the current nominal size.
2102 %
2103 % By the way, simply using "at 1em" works for cmr10 and the like, but
2104 % does not work for cmbx10 and other extended/shrunken fonts.
2105 %
2106 \def\eurosize{\csname\curfontsize nominalsize\endcsname}%
2107 %
2108 \ifx\curfontstyle\bfstylename
2109 % bold:
2110 \font\thiseurofont = \ifusingit{feybo10}{feybr10} at \eurosize
2111 \else
2112 % regular:
2113 \font\thiseurofont = \ifusingit{feymo10}{feymr10} at \eurosize
2114 \fi
2115 \thiseurofont
2116 }
2117
2118 % @registeredsymbol - R in a circle. The font for the R should really
2119 % be smaller yet, but lllsize is the best we can do for now.
2120 % Adapted from the plain.tex definition of \copyright.
2121 %
2122 \def\registeredsymbol{%
2123 $^{{\ooalign{\hfil\raise.07ex\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize R}%
2124 \hfil\crcr\Orb}}%
2125 }$%
2126 }
2127
2128 % Laurent Siebenmann reports \Orb undefined with:
2129 % Textures 1.7.7 (preloaded format=plain 93.10.14) (68K) 16 APR 2004 02:38
2130 % so we'll define it if necessary.
2131 %
2132 \ifx\Orb\undefined
2133 \def\Orb{\mathhexbox20D}
2134 \fi
2135
2136
2137 \message{page headings,}
2138
2139 \newskip\titlepagetopglue \titlepagetopglue = 1.5in
2140 \newskip\titlepagebottomglue \titlepagebottomglue = 2pc
2141
2142 % First the title page. Must do @settitle before @titlepage.
2143 \newif\ifseenauthor
2144 \newif\iffinishedtitlepage
2145
2146 % Do an implicit @contents or @shortcontents after @end titlepage if the
2147 % user says @setcontentsaftertitlepage or @setshortcontentsaftertitlepage.
2148 %
2149 \newif\ifsetcontentsaftertitlepage
2150 \let\setcontentsaftertitlepage = \setcontentsaftertitlepagetrue
2151 \newif\ifsetshortcontentsaftertitlepage
2152 \let\setshortcontentsaftertitlepage = \setshortcontentsaftertitlepagetrue
2153
2154 \parseargdef\shorttitlepage{\begingroup\hbox{}\vskip 1.5in \chaprm \centerline{#1}%
2155 \endgroup\page\hbox{}\page}
2156
2157 \envdef\titlepage{%
2158 % Open one extra group, as we want to close it in the middle of \Etitlepage.
2159 \begingroup
2160 \parindent=0pt \textfonts
2161 % Leave some space at the very top of the page.
2162 \vglue\titlepagetopglue
2163 % No rule at page bottom unless we print one at the top with @title.
2164 \finishedtitlepagetrue
2165 %
2166 % Most title ``pages'' are actually two pages long, with space
2167 % at the top of the second. We don't want the ragged left on the second.
2168 \let\oldpage = \page
2169 \def\page{%
2170 \iffinishedtitlepage\else
2171 \finishtitlepage
2172 \fi
2173 \let\page = \oldpage
2174 \page
2175 \null
2176 }%
2177 }
2178
2179 \def\Etitlepage{%
2180 \iffinishedtitlepage\else
2181 \finishtitlepage
2182 \fi
2183 % It is important to do the page break before ending the group,
2184 % because the headline and footline are only empty inside the group.
2185 % If we use the new definition of \page, we always get a blank page
2186 % after the title page, which we certainly don't want.
2187 \oldpage
2188 \endgroup
2189 %
2190 % Need this before the \...aftertitlepage checks so that if they are
2191 % in effect the toc pages will come out with page numbers.
2192 \HEADINGSon
2193 %
2194 % If they want short, they certainly want long too.
2195 \ifsetshortcontentsaftertitlepage
2196 \shortcontents
2197 \contents
2198 \global\let\shortcontents = \relax
2199 \global\let\contents = \relax
2200 \fi
2201 %
2202 \ifsetcontentsaftertitlepage
2203 \contents
2204 \global\let\contents = \relax
2205 \global\let\shortcontents = \relax
2206 \fi
2207 }
2208
2209 \def\finishtitlepage{%
2210 \vskip4pt \hrule height 2pt width \hsize
2211 \vskip\titlepagebottomglue
2212 \finishedtitlepagetrue
2213 }
2214
2215 %%% Macros to be used within @titlepage:
2216
2217 \let\subtitlerm=\tenrm
2218 \def\subtitlefont{\subtitlerm \normalbaselineskip = 13pt \normalbaselines}
2219
2220 \def\authorfont{\authorrm \normalbaselineskip = 16pt \normalbaselines
2221 \let\tt=\authortt}
2222
2223 \parseargdef\title{%
2224 \checkenv\titlepage
2225 \leftline{\titlefonts\rm #1}
2226 % print a rule at the page bottom also.
2227 \finishedtitlepagefalse
2228 \vskip4pt \hrule height 4pt width \hsize \vskip4pt
2229 }
2230
2231 \parseargdef\subtitle{%
2232 \checkenv\titlepage
2233 {\subtitlefont \rightline{#1}}%
2234 }
2235
2236 % @author should come last, but may come many times.
2237 % It can also be used inside @quotation.
2238 %
2239 \parseargdef\author{%
2240 \def\temp{\quotation}%
2241 \ifx\thisenv\temp
2242 \def\quotationauthor{#1}% printed in \Equotation.
2243 \else
2244 \checkenv\titlepage
2245 \ifseenauthor\else \vskip 0pt plus 1filll \seenauthortrue \fi
2246 {\authorfont \leftline{#1}}%
2247 \fi
2248 }
2249
2250
2251 %%% Set up page headings and footings.
2252
2253 \let\thispage=\folio
2254
2255 \newtoks\evenheadline % headline on even pages
2256 \newtoks\oddheadline % headline on odd pages
2257 \newtoks\evenfootline % footline on even pages
2258 \newtoks\oddfootline % footline on odd pages
2259
2260 % Now make TeX use those variables
2261 \headline={{\textfonts\rm \ifodd\pageno \the\oddheadline
2262 \else \the\evenheadline \fi}}
2263 \footline={{\textfonts\rm \ifodd\pageno \the\oddfootline
2264 \else \the\evenfootline \fi}\HEADINGShook}
2265 \let\HEADINGShook=\relax
2266
2267 % Commands to set those variables.
2268 % For example, this is what @headings on does
2269 % @evenheading @thistitle|@thispage|@thischapter
2270 % @oddheading @thischapter|@thispage|@thistitle
2271 % @evenfooting @thisfile||
2272 % @oddfooting ||@thisfile
2273
2274
2275 \def\evenheading{\parsearg\evenheadingxxx}
2276 \def\evenheadingxxx #1{\evenheadingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish}
2277 \def\evenheadingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{%
2278 \global\evenheadline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}}
2279
2280 \def\oddheading{\parsearg\oddheadingxxx}
2281 \def\oddheadingxxx #1{\oddheadingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish}
2282 \def\oddheadingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{%
2283 \global\oddheadline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}}
2284
2285 \parseargdef\everyheading{\oddheadingxxx{#1}\evenheadingxxx{#1}}%
2286
2287 \def\evenfooting{\parsearg\evenfootingxxx}
2288 \def\evenfootingxxx #1{\evenfootingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish}
2289 \def\evenfootingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{%
2290 \global\evenfootline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}}
2291
2292 \def\oddfooting{\parsearg\oddfootingxxx}
2293 \def\oddfootingxxx #1{\oddfootingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish}
2294 \def\oddfootingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{%
2295 \global\oddfootline = {\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}%
2296 %
2297 % Leave some space for the footline. Hopefully ok to assume
2298 % @evenfooting will not be used by itself.
2299 \global\advance\pageheight by -\baselineskip
2300 \global\advance\vsize by -\baselineskip
2301 }
2302
2303 \parseargdef\everyfooting{\oddfootingxxx{#1}\evenfootingxxx{#1}}
2304
2305
2306 % @headings double turns headings on for double-sided printing.
2307 % @headings single turns headings on for single-sided printing.
2308 % @headings off turns them off.
2309 % @headings on same as @headings double, retained for compatibility.
2310 % @headings after turns on double-sided headings after this page.
2311 % @headings doubleafter turns on double-sided headings after this page.
2312 % @headings singleafter turns on single-sided headings after this page.
2313 % By default, they are off at the start of a document,
2314 % and turned `on' after @end titlepage.
2315
2316 \def\headings #1 {\csname HEADINGS#1\endcsname}
2317
2318 \def\HEADINGSoff{%
2319 \global\evenheadline={\hfil} \global\evenfootline={\hfil}
2320 \global\oddheadline={\hfil} \global\oddfootline={\hfil}}
2321 \HEADINGSoff
2322 % When we turn headings on, set the page number to 1.
2323 % For double-sided printing, put current file name in lower left corner,
2324 % chapter name on inside top of right hand pages, document
2325 % title on inside top of left hand pages, and page numbers on outside top
2326 % edge of all pages.
2327 \def\HEADINGSdouble{%
2328 \global\pageno=1
2329 \global\evenfootline={\hfil}
2330 \global\oddfootline={\hfil}
2331 \global\evenheadline={\line{\folio\hfil\thistitle}}
2332 \global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
2333 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chapoddpage
2334 }
2335 \let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager
2336
2337 % For single-sided printing, chapter title goes across top left of page,
2338 % page number on top right.
2339 \def\HEADINGSsingle{%
2340 \global\pageno=1
2341 \global\evenfootline={\hfil}
2342 \global\oddfootline={\hfil}
2343 \global\evenheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
2344 \global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
2345 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager
2346 }
2347 \def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSdouble}
2348
2349 \def\HEADINGSafter{\let\HEADINGShook=\HEADINGSdoublex}
2350 \let\HEADINGSdoubleafter=\HEADINGSafter
2351 \def\HEADINGSdoublex{%
2352 \global\evenfootline={\hfil}
2353 \global\oddfootline={\hfil}
2354 \global\evenheadline={\line{\folio\hfil\thistitle}}
2355 \global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
2356 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chapoddpage
2357 }
2358
2359 \def\HEADINGSsingleafter{\let\HEADINGShook=\HEADINGSsinglex}
2360 \def\HEADINGSsinglex{%
2361 \global\evenfootline={\hfil}
2362 \global\oddfootline={\hfil}
2363 \global\evenheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
2364 \global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
2365 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager
2366 }
2367
2368 % Subroutines used in generating headings
2369 % This produces Day Month Year style of output.
2370 % Only define if not already defined, in case a txi-??.tex file has set
2371 % up a different format (e.g., txi-cs.tex does this).
2372 \ifx\today\undefined
2373 \def\today{%
2374 \number\day\space
2375 \ifcase\month
2376 \or\putwordMJan\or\putwordMFeb\or\putwordMMar\or\putwordMApr
2377 \or\putwordMMay\or\putwordMJun\or\putwordMJul\or\putwordMAug
2378 \or\putwordMSep\or\putwordMOct\or\putwordMNov\or\putwordMDec
2379 \fi
2380 \space\number\year}
2381 \fi
2382
2383 % @settitle line... specifies the title of the document, for headings.
2384 % It generates no output of its own.
2385 \def\thistitle{\putwordNoTitle}
2386 \def\settitle{\parsearg{\gdef\thistitle}}
2387
2388
2389 \message{tables,}
2390 % Tables -- @table, @ftable, @vtable, @item(x).
2391
2392 % default indentation of table text
2393 \newdimen\tableindent \tableindent=.8in
2394 % default indentation of @itemize and @enumerate text
2395 \newdimen\itemindent \itemindent=.3in
2396 % margin between end of table item and start of table text.
2397 \newdimen\itemmargin \itemmargin=.1in
2398
2399 % used internally for \itemindent minus \itemmargin
2400 \newdimen\itemmax
2401
2402 % Note @table, @ftable, and @vtable define @item, @itemx, etc., with
2403 % these defs.
2404 % They also define \itemindex
2405 % to index the item name in whatever manner is desired (perhaps none).
2406
2407 \newif\ifitemxneedsnegativevskip
2408
2409 \def\itemxpar{\par\ifitemxneedsnegativevskip\nobreak\vskip-\parskip\nobreak\fi}
2410
2411 \def\internalBitem{\smallbreak \parsearg\itemzzz}
2412 \def\internalBitemx{\itemxpar \parsearg\itemzzz}
2413
2414 \def\itemzzz #1{\begingroup %
2415 \advance\hsize by -\rightskip
2416 \advance\hsize by -\tableindent
2417 \setbox0=\hbox{\itemindicate{#1}}%
2418 \itemindex{#1}%
2419 \nobreak % This prevents a break before @itemx.
2420 %
2421 % If the item text does not fit in the space we have, put it on a line
2422 % by itself, and do not allow a page break either before or after that
2423 % line. We do not start a paragraph here because then if the next
2424 % command is, e.g., @kindex, the whatsit would get put into the
2425 % horizontal list on a line by itself, resulting in extra blank space.
2426 \ifdim \wd0>\itemmax
2427 %
2428 % Make this a paragraph so we get the \parskip glue and wrapping,
2429 % but leave it ragged-right.
2430 \begingroup
2431 \advance\leftskip by-\tableindent
2432 \advance\hsize by\tableindent
2433 \advance\rightskip by0pt plus1fil
2434 \leavevmode\unhbox0\par
2435 \endgroup
2436 %
2437 % We're going to be starting a paragraph, but we don't want the
2438 % \parskip glue -- logically it's part of the @item we just started.
2439 \nobreak \vskip-\parskip
2440 %
2441 % Stop a page break at the \parskip glue coming up. However, if
2442 % what follows is an environment such as @example, there will be no
2443 % \parskip glue; then the negative vskip we just inserted would
2444 % cause the example and the item to crash together. So we use this
2445 % bizarre value of 10001 as a signal to \aboveenvbreak to insert
2446 % \parskip glue after all. Section titles are handled this way also.
2447 %
2448 \penalty 10001
2449 \endgroup
2450 \itemxneedsnegativevskipfalse
2451 \else
2452 % The item text fits into the space. Start a paragraph, so that the
2453 % following text (if any) will end up on the same line.
2454 \noindent
2455 % Do this with kerns and \unhbox so that if there is a footnote in
2456 % the item text, it can migrate to the main vertical list and
2457 % eventually be printed.
2458 \nobreak\kern-\tableindent
2459 \dimen0 = \itemmax \advance\dimen0 by \itemmargin \advance\dimen0 by -\wd0
2460 \unhbox0
2461 \nobreak\kern\dimen0
2462 \endgroup
2463 \itemxneedsnegativevskiptrue
2464 \fi
2465 }
2466
2467 \def\item{\errmessage{@item while not in a list environment}}
2468 \def\itemx{\errmessage{@itemx while not in a list environment}}
2469
2470 % @table, @ftable, @vtable.
2471 \envdef\table{%
2472 \let\itemindex\gobble
2473 \tablecheck{table}%
2474 }
2475 \envdef\ftable{%
2476 \def\itemindex ##1{\doind {fn}{\code{##1}}}%
2477 \tablecheck{ftable}%
2478 }
2479 \envdef\vtable{%
2480 \def\itemindex ##1{\doind {vr}{\code{##1}}}%
2481 \tablecheck{vtable}%
2482 }
2483 \def\tablecheck#1{%
2484 \ifnum \the\catcode`\^^M=\active
2485 \endgroup
2486 \errmessage{This command won't work in this context; perhaps the problem is
2487 that we are \inenvironment\thisenv}%
2488 \def\next{\doignore{#1}}%
2489 \else
2490 \let\next\tablex
2491 \fi
2492 \next
2493 }
2494 \def\tablex#1{%
2495 \def\itemindicate{#1}%
2496 \parsearg\tabley
2497 }
2498 \def\tabley#1{%
2499 {%
2500 \makevalueexpandable
2501 \edef\temp{\noexpand\tablez #1\space\space\space}%
2502 \expandafter
2503 }\temp \endtablez
2504 }
2505 \def\tablez #1 #2 #3 #4\endtablez{%
2506 \aboveenvbreak
2507 \ifnum 0#1>0 \advance \leftskip by #1\mil \fi
2508 \ifnum 0#2>0 \tableindent=#2\mil \fi
2509 \ifnum 0#3>0 \advance \rightskip by #3\mil \fi
2510 \itemmax=\tableindent
2511 \advance \itemmax by -\itemmargin
2512 \advance \leftskip by \tableindent
2513 \exdentamount=\tableindent
2514 \parindent = 0pt
2515 \parskip = \smallskipamount
2516 \ifdim \parskip=0pt \parskip=2pt \fi
2517 \let\item = \internalBitem
2518 \let\itemx = \internalBitemx
2519 }
2520 \def\Etable{\endgraf\afterenvbreak}
2521 \let\Eftable\Etable
2522 \let\Evtable\Etable
2523 \let\Eitemize\Etable
2524 \let\Eenumerate\Etable
2525
2526 % This is the counter used by @enumerate, which is really @itemize
2527
2528 \newcount \itemno
2529
2530 \envdef\itemize{\parsearg\doitemize}
2531
2532 \def\doitemize#1{%
2533 \aboveenvbreak
2534 \itemmax=\itemindent
2535 \advance\itemmax by -\itemmargin
2536 \advance\leftskip by \itemindent
2537 \exdentamount=\itemindent
2538 \parindent=0pt
2539 \parskip=\smallskipamount
2540 \ifdim\parskip=0pt \parskip=2pt \fi
2541 \def\itemcontents{#1}%
2542 % @itemize with no arg is equivalent to @itemize @bullet.
2543 \ifx\itemcontents\empty\def\itemcontents{\bullet}\fi
2544 \let\item=\itemizeitem
2545 }
2546
2547 % Definition of @item while inside @itemize and @enumerate.
2548 %
2549 \def\itemizeitem{%
2550 \advance\itemno by 1 % for enumerations
2551 {\let\par=\endgraf \smallbreak}% reasonable place to break
2552 {%
2553 % If the document has an @itemize directly after a section title, a
2554 % \nobreak will be last on the list, and \sectionheading will have
2555 % done a \vskip-\parskip. In that case, we don't want to zero
2556 % parskip, or the item text will crash with the heading. On the
2557 % other hand, when there is normal text preceding the item (as there
2558 % usually is), we do want to zero parskip, or there would be too much
2559 % space. In that case, we won't have a \nobreak before. At least
2560 % that's the theory.
2561 \ifnum\lastpenalty<10000 \parskip=0in \fi
2562 \noindent
2563 \hbox to 0pt{\hss \itemcontents \kern\itemmargin}%
2564 \vadjust{\penalty 1200}}% not good to break after first line of item.
2565 \flushcr
2566 }
2567
2568 % \splitoff TOKENS\endmark defines \first to be the first token in
2569 % TOKENS, and \rest to be the remainder.
2570 %
2571 \def\splitoff#1#2\endmark{\def\first{#1}\def\rest{#2}}%
2572
2573 % Allow an optional argument of an uppercase letter, lowercase letter,
2574 % or number, to specify the first label in the enumerated list. No
2575 % argument is the same as `1'.
2576 %
2577 \envparseargdef\enumerate{\enumeratey #1 \endenumeratey}
2578 \def\enumeratey #1 #2\endenumeratey{%
2579 % If we were given no argument, pretend we were given `1'.
2580 \def\thearg{#1}%
2581 \ifx\thearg\empty \def\thearg{1}\fi
2582 %
2583 % Detect if the argument is a single token. If so, it might be a
2584 % letter. Otherwise, the only valid thing it can be is a number.
2585 % (We will always have one token, because of the test we just made.
2586 % This is a good thing, since \splitoff doesn't work given nothing at
2587 % all -- the first parameter is undelimited.)
2588 \expandafter\splitoff\thearg\endmark
2589 \ifx\rest\empty
2590 % Only one token in the argument. It could still be anything.
2591 % A ``lowercase letter'' is one whose \lccode is nonzero.
2592 % An ``uppercase letter'' is one whose \lccode is both nonzero, and
2593 % not equal to itself.
2594 % Otherwise, we assume it's a number.
2595 %
2596 % We need the \relax at the end of the \ifnum lines to stop TeX from
2597 % continuing to look for a <number>.
2598 %
2599 \ifnum\lccode\expandafter`\thearg=0\relax
2600 \numericenumerate % a number (we hope)
2601 \else
2602 % It's a letter.
2603 \ifnum\lccode\expandafter`\thearg=\expandafter`\thearg\relax
2604 \lowercaseenumerate % lowercase letter
2605 \else
2606 \uppercaseenumerate % uppercase letter
2607 \fi
2608 \fi
2609 \else
2610 % Multiple tokens in the argument. We hope it's a number.
2611 \numericenumerate
2612 \fi
2613 }
2614
2615 % An @enumerate whose labels are integers. The starting integer is
2616 % given in \thearg.
2617 %
2618 \def\numericenumerate{%
2619 \itemno = \thearg
2620 \startenumeration{\the\itemno}%
2621 }
2622
2623 % The starting (lowercase) letter is in \thearg.
2624 \def\lowercaseenumerate{%
2625 \itemno = \expandafter`\thearg
2626 \startenumeration{%
2627 % Be sure we're not beyond the end of the alphabet.
2628 \ifnum\itemno=0
2629 \errmessage{No more lowercase letters in @enumerate; get a bigger
2630 alphabet}%
2631 \fi
2632 \char\lccode\itemno
2633 }%
2634 }
2635
2636 % The starting (uppercase) letter is in \thearg.
2637 \def\uppercaseenumerate{%
2638 \itemno = \expandafter`\thearg
2639 \startenumeration{%
2640 % Be sure we're not beyond the end of the alphabet.
2641 \ifnum\itemno=0
2642 \errmessage{No more uppercase letters in @enumerate; get a bigger
2643 alphabet}
2644 \fi
2645 \char\uccode\itemno
2646 }%
2647 }
2648
2649 % Call \doitemize, adding a period to the first argument and supplying the
2650 % common last two arguments. Also subtract one from the initial value in
2651 % \itemno, since @item increments \itemno.
2652 %
2653 \def\startenumeration#1{%
2654 \advance\itemno by -1
2655 \doitemize{#1.}\flushcr
2656 }
2657
2658 % @alphaenumerate and @capsenumerate are abbreviations for giving an arg
2659 % to @enumerate.
2660 %
2661 \def\alphaenumerate{\enumerate{a}}
2662 \def\capsenumerate{\enumerate{A}}
2663 \def\Ealphaenumerate{\Eenumerate}
2664 \def\Ecapsenumerate{\Eenumerate}
2665
2666
2667 % @multitable macros
2668 % Amy Hendrickson, 8/18/94, 3/6/96
2669 %
2670 % @multitable ... @end multitable will make as many columns as desired.
2671 % Contents of each column will wrap at width given in preamble. Width
2672 % can be specified either with sample text given in a template line,
2673 % or in percent of \hsize, the current width of text on page.
2674
2675 % Table can continue over pages but will only break between lines.
2676
2677 % To make preamble:
2678 %
2679 % Either define widths of columns in terms of percent of \hsize:
2680 % @multitable @columnfractions .25 .3 .45
2681 % @item ...
2682 %
2683 % Numbers following @columnfractions are the percent of the total
2684 % current hsize to be used for each column. You may use as many
2685 % columns as desired.
2686
2687
2688 % Or use a template:
2689 % @multitable {Column 1 template} {Column 2 template} {Column 3 template}
2690 % @item ...
2691 % using the widest term desired in each column.
2692
2693 % Each new table line starts with @item, each subsequent new column
2694 % starts with @tab. Empty columns may be produced by supplying @tab's
2695 % with nothing between them for as many times as empty columns are needed,
2696 % ie, @tab@tab@tab will produce two empty columns.
2697
2698 % @item, @tab do not need to be on their own lines, but it will not hurt
2699 % if they are.
2700
2701 % Sample multitable:
2702
2703 % @multitable {Column 1 template} {Column 2 template} {Column 3 template}
2704 % @item first col stuff @tab second col stuff @tab third col
2705 % @item
2706 % first col stuff
2707 % @tab
2708 % second col stuff
2709 % @tab
2710 % third col
2711 % @item first col stuff @tab second col stuff
2712 % @tab Many paragraphs of text may be used in any column.
2713 %
2714 % They will wrap at the width determined by the template.
2715 % @item@tab@tab This will be in third column.
2716 % @end multitable
2717
2718 % Default dimensions may be reset by user.
2719 % @multitableparskip is vertical space between paragraphs in table.
2720 % @multitableparindent is paragraph indent in table.
2721 % @multitablecolmargin is horizontal space to be left between columns.
2722 % @multitablelinespace is space to leave between table items, baseline
2723 % to baseline.
2724 % 0pt means it depends on current normal line spacing.
2725 %
2726 \newskip\multitableparskip
2727 \newskip\multitableparindent
2728 \newdimen\multitablecolspace
2729 \newskip\multitablelinespace
2730 \multitableparskip=0pt
2731 \multitableparindent=6pt
2732 \multitablecolspace=12pt
2733 \multitablelinespace=0pt
2734
2735 % Macros used to set up halign preamble:
2736 %
2737 \let\endsetuptable\relax
2738 \def\xendsetuptable{\endsetuptable}
2739 \let\columnfractions\relax
2740 \def\xcolumnfractions{\columnfractions}
2741 \newif\ifsetpercent
2742
2743 % #1 is the @columnfraction, usually a decimal number like .5, but might
2744 % be just 1. We just use it, whatever it is.
2745 %
2746 \def\pickupwholefraction#1 {%
2747 \global\advance\colcount by 1
2748 \expandafter\xdef\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname{#1\hsize}%
2749 \setuptable
2750 }
2751
2752 \newcount\colcount
2753 \def\setuptable#1{%
2754 \def\firstarg{#1}%
2755 \ifx\firstarg\xendsetuptable
2756 \let\go = \relax
2757 \else
2758 \ifx\firstarg\xcolumnfractions
2759 \global\setpercenttrue
2760 \else
2761 \ifsetpercent
2762 \let\go\pickupwholefraction
2763 \else
2764 \global\advance\colcount by 1
2765 \setbox0=\hbox{#1\unskip\space}% Add a normal word space as a
2766 % separator; typically that is always in the input, anyway.
2767 \expandafter\xdef\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname{\the\wd0}%
2768 \fi
2769 \fi
2770 \ifx\go\pickupwholefraction
2771 % Put the argument back for the \pickupwholefraction call, so
2772 % we'll always have a period there to be parsed.
2773 \def\go{\pickupwholefraction#1}%
2774 \else
2775 \let\go = \setuptable
2776 \fi%
2777 \fi
2778 \go
2779 }
2780
2781 % multitable-only commands.
2782 %
2783 % @headitem starts a heading row, which we typeset in bold.
2784 % Assignments have to be global since we are inside the implicit group
2785 % of an alignment entry. Note that \everycr resets \everytab.
2786 \def\headitem{\checkenv\multitable \crcr \global\everytab={\bf}\the\everytab}%
2787 %
2788 % A \tab used to include \hskip1sp. But then the space in a template
2789 % line is not enough. That is bad. So let's go back to just `&' until
2790 % we encounter the problem it was intended to solve again.
2791 % --karl, nathan@acm.org, 20apr99.
2792 \def\tab{\checkenv\multitable &\the\everytab}%
2793
2794 % @multitable ... @end multitable definitions:
2795 %
2796 \newtoks\everytab % insert after every tab.
2797 %
2798 \envdef\multitable{%
2799 \vskip\parskip
2800 \startsavinginserts
2801 %
2802 % @item within a multitable starts a normal row.
2803 % We use \def instead of \let so that if one of the multitable entries
2804 % contains an @itemize, we don't choke on the \item (seen as \crcr aka
2805 % \endtemplate) expanding \doitemize.
2806 \def\item{\crcr}%
2807 %
2808 \tolerance=9500
2809 \hbadness=9500
2810 \setmultitablespacing
2811 \parskip=\multitableparskip
2812 \parindent=\multitableparindent
2813 \overfullrule=0pt
2814 \global\colcount=0
2815 %
2816 \everycr = {%
2817 \noalign{%
2818 \global\everytab={}%
2819 \global\colcount=0 % Reset the column counter.
2820 % Check for saved footnotes, etc.
2821 \checkinserts
2822 % Keeps underfull box messages off when table breaks over pages.
2823 %\filbreak
2824 % Maybe so, but it also creates really weird page breaks when the
2825 % table breaks over pages. Wouldn't \vfil be better? Wait until the
2826 % problem manifests itself, so it can be fixed for real --karl.
2827 }%
2828 }%
2829 %
2830 \parsearg\domultitable
2831 }
2832 \def\domultitable#1{%
2833 % To parse everything between @multitable and @item:
2834 \setuptable#1 \endsetuptable
2835 %
2836 % This preamble sets up a generic column definition, which will
2837 % be used as many times as user calls for columns.
2838 % \vtop will set a single line and will also let text wrap and
2839 % continue for many paragraphs if desired.
2840 \halign\bgroup &%
2841 \global\advance\colcount by 1
2842 \multistrut
2843 \vtop{%
2844 % Use the current \colcount to find the correct column width:
2845 \hsize=\expandafter\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname
2846 %
2847 % In order to keep entries from bumping into each other
2848 % we will add a \leftskip of \multitablecolspace to all columns after
2849 % the first one.
2850 %
2851 % If a template has been used, we will add \multitablecolspace
2852 % to the width of each template entry.
2853 %
2854 % If the user has set preamble in terms of percent of \hsize we will
2855 % use that dimension as the width of the column, and the \leftskip
2856 % will keep entries from bumping into each other. Table will start at
2857 % left margin and final column will justify at right margin.
2858 %
2859 % Make sure we don't inherit \rightskip from the outer environment.
2860 \rightskip=0pt
2861 \ifnum\colcount=1
2862 % The first column will be indented with the surrounding text.
2863 \advance\hsize by\leftskip
2864 \else
2865 \ifsetpercent \else
2866 % If user has not set preamble in terms of percent of \hsize
2867 % we will advance \hsize by \multitablecolspace.
2868 \advance\hsize by \multitablecolspace
2869 \fi
2870 % In either case we will make \leftskip=\multitablecolspace:
2871 \leftskip=\multitablecolspace
2872 \fi
2873 % Ignoring space at the beginning and end avoids an occasional spurious
2874 % blank line, when TeX decides to break the line at the space before the
2875 % box from the multistrut, so the strut ends up on a line by itself.
2876 % For example:
2877 % @multitable @columnfractions .11 .89
2878 % @item @code{#}
2879 % @tab Legal holiday which is valid in major parts of the whole country.
2880 % Is automatically provided with highlighting sequences respectively
2881 % marking characters.
2882 \noindent\ignorespaces##\unskip\multistrut
2883 }\cr
2884 }
2885 \def\Emultitable{%
2886 \crcr
2887 \egroup % end the \halign
2888 \global\setpercentfalse
2889 }
2890
2891 \def\setmultitablespacing{%
2892 \def\multistrut{\strut}% just use the standard line spacing
2893 %
2894 % Compute \multitablelinespace (if not defined by user) for use in
2895 % \multitableparskip calculation. We used define \multistrut based on
2896 % this, but (ironically) that caused the spacing to be off.
2897 % See bug-texinfo report from Werner Lemberg, 31 Oct 2004 12:52:20 +0100.
2898 \ifdim\multitablelinespace=0pt
2899 \setbox0=\vbox{X}\global\multitablelinespace=\the\baselineskip
2900 \global\advance\multitablelinespace by-\ht0
2901 \fi
2902 %% Test to see if parskip is larger than space between lines of
2903 %% table. If not, do nothing.
2904 %% If so, set to same dimension as multitablelinespace.
2905 \ifdim\multitableparskip>\multitablelinespace
2906 \global\multitableparskip=\multitablelinespace
2907 \global\advance\multitableparskip-7pt %% to keep parskip somewhat smaller
2908 %% than skip between lines in the table.
2909 \fi%
2910 \ifdim\multitableparskip=0pt
2911 \global\multitableparskip=\multitablelinespace
2912 \global\advance\multitableparskip-7pt %% to keep parskip somewhat smaller
2913 %% than skip between lines in the table.
2914 \fi}
2915
2916
2917 \message{conditionals,}
2918
2919 % @iftex, @ifnotdocbook, @ifnothtml, @ifnotinfo, @ifnotplaintext,
2920 % @ifnotxml always succeed. They currently do nothing; we don't
2921 % attempt to check whether the conditionals are properly nested. But we
2922 % have to remember that they are conditionals, so that @end doesn't
2923 % attempt to close an environment group.
2924 %
2925 \def\makecond#1{%
2926 \expandafter\let\csname #1\endcsname = \relax
2927 \expandafter\let\csname iscond.#1\endcsname = 1
2928 }
2929 \makecond{iftex}
2930 \makecond{ifnotdocbook}
2931 \makecond{ifnothtml}
2932 \makecond{ifnotinfo}
2933 \makecond{ifnotplaintext}
2934 \makecond{ifnotxml}
2935
2936 % Ignore @ignore, @ifhtml, @ifinfo, and the like.
2937 %
2938 \def\direntry{\doignore{direntry}}
2939 \def\documentdescription{\doignore{documentdescription}}
2940 \def\docbook{\doignore{docbook}}
2941 \def\html{\doignore{html}}
2942 \def\ifdocbook{\doignore{ifdocbook}}
2943 \def\ifhtml{\doignore{ifhtml}}
2944 \def\ifinfo{\doignore{ifinfo}}
2945 \def\ifnottex{\doignore{ifnottex}}
2946 \def\ifplaintext{\doignore{ifplaintext}}
2947 \def\ifxml{\doignore{ifxml}}
2948 \def\ignore{\doignore{ignore}}
2949 \def\menu{\doignore{menu}}
2950 \def\xml{\doignore{xml}}
2951
2952 % Ignore text until a line `@end #1', keeping track of nested conditionals.
2953 %
2954 % A count to remember the depth of nesting.
2955 \newcount\doignorecount
2956
2957 \def\doignore#1{\begingroup
2958 % Scan in ``verbatim'' mode:
2959 \obeylines
2960 \catcode`\@ = \other
2961 \catcode`\{ = \other
2962 \catcode`\} = \other
2963 %
2964 % Make sure that spaces turn into tokens that match what \doignoretext wants.
2965 \spaceisspace
2966 %
2967 % Count number of #1's that we've seen.
2968 \doignorecount = 0
2969 %
2970 % Swallow text until we reach the matching `@end #1'.
2971 \dodoignore{#1}%
2972 }
2973
2974 { \catcode`_=11 % We want to use \_STOP_ which cannot appear in texinfo source.
2975 \obeylines %
2976 %
2977 \gdef\dodoignore#1{%
2978 % #1 contains the command name as a string, e.g., `ifinfo'.
2979 %
2980 % Define a command to find the next `@end #1'.
2981 \long\def\doignoretext##1^^M@end #1{%
2982 \doignoretextyyy##1^^M@#1\_STOP_}%
2983 %
2984 % And this command to find another #1 command, at the beginning of a
2985 % line. (Otherwise, we would consider a line `@c @ifset', for
2986 % example, to count as an @ifset for nesting.)
2987 \long\def\doignoretextyyy##1^^M@#1##2\_STOP_{\doignoreyyy{##2}\_STOP_}%
2988 %
2989 % And now expand that command.
2990 \doignoretext ^^M%
2991 }%
2992 }
2993
2994 \def\doignoreyyy#1{%
2995 \def\temp{#1}%
2996 \ifx\temp\empty % Nothing found.
2997 \let\next\doignoretextzzz
2998 \else % Found a nested condition, ...
2999 \advance\doignorecount by 1
3000 \let\next\doignoretextyyy % ..., look for another.
3001 % If we're here, #1 ends with ^^M\ifinfo (for example).
3002 \fi
3003 \next #1% the token \_STOP_ is present just after this macro.
3004 }
3005
3006 % We have to swallow the remaining "\_STOP_".
3007 %
3008 \def\doignoretextzzz#1{%
3009 \ifnum\doignorecount = 0 % We have just found the outermost @end.
3010 \let\next\enddoignore
3011 \else % Still inside a nested condition.
3012 \advance\doignorecount by -1
3013 \let\next\doignoretext % Look for the next @end.
3014 \fi
3015 \next
3016 }
3017
3018 % Finish off ignored text.
3019 { \obeylines%
3020 % Ignore anything after the last `@end #1'; this matters in verbatim
3021 % environments, where otherwise the newline after an ignored conditional
3022 % would result in a blank line in the output.
3023 \gdef\enddoignore#1^^M{\endgroup\ignorespaces}%
3024 }
3025
3026
3027 % @set VAR sets the variable VAR to an empty value.
3028 % @set VAR REST-OF-LINE sets VAR to the value REST-OF-LINE.
3029 %
3030 % Since we want to separate VAR from REST-OF-LINE (which might be
3031 % empty), we can't just use \parsearg; we have to insert a space of our
3032 % own to delimit the rest of the line, and then take it out again if we
3033 % didn't need it.
3034 % We rely on the fact that \parsearg sets \catcode`\ =10.
3035 %
3036 \parseargdef\set{\setyyy#1 \endsetyyy}
3037 \def\setyyy#1 #2\endsetyyy{%
3038 {%
3039 \makevalueexpandable
3040 \def\temp{#2}%
3041 \edef\next{\gdef\makecsname{SET#1}}%
3042 \ifx\temp\empty
3043 \next{}%
3044 \else
3045 \setzzz#2\endsetzzz
3046 \fi
3047 }%
3048 }
3049 % Remove the trailing space \setxxx inserted.
3050 \def\setzzz#1 \endsetzzz{\next{#1}}
3051
3052 % @clear VAR clears (i.e., unsets) the variable VAR.
3053 %
3054 \parseargdef\clear{%
3055 {%
3056 \makevalueexpandable
3057 \global\expandafter\let\csname SET#1\endcsname=\relax
3058 }%
3059 }
3060
3061 % @value{foo} gets the text saved in variable foo.
3062 \def\value{\begingroup\makevalueexpandable\valuexxx}
3063 \def\valuexxx#1{\expandablevalue{#1}\endgroup}
3064 {
3065 \catcode`\- = \active \catcode`\_ = \active
3066 %
3067 \gdef\makevalueexpandable{%
3068 \let\value = \expandablevalue
3069 % We don't want these characters active, ...
3070 \catcode`\-=\other \catcode`\_=\other
3071 % ..., but we might end up with active ones in the argument if
3072 % we're called from @code, as @code{@value{foo-bar_}}, though.
3073 % So \let them to their normal equivalents.
3074 \let-\realdash \let_\normalunderscore
3075 }
3076 }
3077
3078 % We have this subroutine so that we can handle at least some @value's
3079 % properly in indexes (we call \makevalueexpandable in \indexdummies).
3080 % The command has to be fully expandable (if the variable is set), since
3081 % the result winds up in the index file. This means that if the
3082 % variable's value contains other Texinfo commands, it's almost certain
3083 % it will fail (although perhaps we could fix that with sufficient work
3084 % to do a one-level expansion on the result, instead of complete).
3085 %
3086 \def\expandablevalue#1{%
3087 \expandafter\ifx\csname SET#1\endcsname\relax
3088 {[No value for ``#1'']}%
3089 \message{Variable `#1', used in @value, is not set.}%
3090 \else
3091 \csname SET#1\endcsname
3092 \fi
3093 }
3094
3095 % @ifset VAR ... @end ifset reads the `...' iff VAR has been defined
3096 % with @set.
3097 %
3098 % To get special treatment of `@end ifset,' call \makeond and the redefine.
3099 %
3100 \makecond{ifset}
3101 \def\ifset{\parsearg{\doifset{\let\next=\ifsetfail}}}
3102 \def\doifset#1#2{%
3103 {%
3104 \makevalueexpandable
3105 \let\next=\empty
3106 \expandafter\ifx\csname SET#2\endcsname\relax
3107 #1% If not set, redefine \next.
3108 \fi
3109 \expandafter
3110 }\next
3111 }
3112 \def\ifsetfail{\doignore{ifset}}
3113
3114 % @ifclear VAR ... @end ifclear reads the `...' iff VAR has never been
3115 % defined with @set, or has been undefined with @clear.
3116 %
3117 % The `\else' inside the `\doifset' parameter is a trick to reuse the
3118 % above code: if the variable is not set, do nothing, if it is set,
3119 % then redefine \next to \ifclearfail.
3120 %
3121 \makecond{ifclear}
3122 \def\ifclear{\parsearg{\doifset{\else \let\next=\ifclearfail}}}
3123 \def\ifclearfail{\doignore{ifclear}}
3124
3125 % @dircategory CATEGORY -- specify a category of the dir file
3126 % which this file should belong to. Ignore this in TeX.
3127 \let\dircategory=\comment
3128
3129 % @defininfoenclose.
3130 \let\definfoenclose=\comment
3131
3132
3133 \message{indexing,}
3134 % Index generation facilities
3135
3136 % Define \newwrite to be identical to plain tex's \newwrite
3137 % except not \outer, so it can be used within macros and \if's.
3138 \edef\newwrite{\makecsname{ptexnewwrite}}
3139
3140 % \newindex {foo} defines an index named foo.
3141 % It automatically defines \fooindex such that
3142 % \fooindex ...rest of line... puts an entry in the index foo.
3143 % It also defines \fooindfile to be the number of the output channel for
3144 % the file that accumulates this index. The file's extension is foo.
3145 % The name of an index should be no more than 2 characters long
3146 % for the sake of vms.
3147 %
3148 \def\newindex#1{%
3149 \iflinks
3150 \expandafter\newwrite \csname#1indfile\endcsname
3151 \openout \csname#1indfile\endcsname \jobname.#1 % Open the file
3152 \fi
3153 \expandafter\xdef\csname#1index\endcsname{% % Define @#1index
3154 \noexpand\doindex{#1}}
3155 }
3156
3157 % @defindex foo == \newindex{foo}
3158 %
3159 \def\defindex{\parsearg\newindex}
3160
3161 % Define @defcodeindex, like @defindex except put all entries in @code.
3162 %
3163 \def\defcodeindex{\parsearg\newcodeindex}
3164 %
3165 \def\newcodeindex#1{%
3166 \iflinks
3167 \expandafter\newwrite \csname#1indfile\endcsname
3168 \openout \csname#1indfile\endcsname \jobname.#1
3169 \fi
3170 \expandafter\xdef\csname#1index\endcsname{%
3171 \noexpand\docodeindex{#1}}%
3172 }
3173
3174
3175 % @synindex foo bar makes index foo feed into index bar.
3176 % Do this instead of @defindex foo if you don't want it as a separate index.
3177 %
3178 % @syncodeindex foo bar similar, but put all entries made for index foo
3179 % inside @code.
3180 %
3181 \def\synindex#1 #2 {\dosynindex\doindex{#1}{#2}}
3182 \def\syncodeindex#1 #2 {\dosynindex\docodeindex{#1}{#2}}
3183
3184 % #1 is \doindex or \docodeindex, #2 the index getting redefined (foo),
3185 % #3 the target index (bar).
3186 \def\dosynindex#1#2#3{%
3187 % Only do \closeout if we haven't already done it, else we'll end up
3188 % closing the target index.
3189 \expandafter \ifx\csname donesynindex#2\endcsname \undefined
3190 % The \closeout helps reduce unnecessary open files; the limit on the
3191 % Acorn RISC OS is a mere 16 files.
3192 \expandafter\closeout\csname#2indfile\endcsname
3193 \expandafter\let\csname\donesynindex#2\endcsname = 1
3194 \fi
3195 % redefine \fooindfile:
3196 \expandafter\let\expandafter\temp\expandafter=\csname#3indfile\endcsname
3197 \expandafter\let\csname#2indfile\endcsname=\temp
3198 % redefine \fooindex:
3199 \expandafter\xdef\csname#2index\endcsname{\noexpand#1{#3}}%
3200 }
3201
3202 % Define \doindex, the driver for all \fooindex macros.
3203 % Argument #1 is generated by the calling \fooindex macro,
3204 % and it is "foo", the name of the index.
3205
3206 % \doindex just uses \parsearg; it calls \doind for the actual work.
3207 % This is because \doind is more useful to call from other macros.
3208
3209 % There is also \dosubind {index}{topic}{subtopic}
3210 % which makes an entry in a two-level index such as the operation index.
3211
3212 \def\doindex#1{\edef\indexname{#1}\parsearg\singleindexer}
3213 \def\singleindexer #1{\doind{\indexname}{#1}}
3214
3215 % like the previous two, but they put @code around the argument.
3216 \def\docodeindex#1{\edef\indexname{#1}\parsearg\singlecodeindexer}
3217 \def\singlecodeindexer #1{\doind{\indexname}{\code{#1}}}
3218
3219 % Take care of Texinfo commands that can appear in an index entry.
3220 % Since there are some commands we want to expand, and others we don't,
3221 % we have to laboriously prevent expansion for those that we don't.
3222 %
3223 \def\indexdummies{%
3224 \escapechar = `\\ % use backslash in output files.
3225 \def\@{@}% change to @@ when we switch to @ as escape char in index files.
3226 \def\ {\realbackslash\space }%
3227 % Need these in case \tex is in effect and \{ is a \delimiter again.
3228 % But can't use \lbracecmd and \rbracecmd because texindex assumes
3229 % braces and backslashes are used only as delimiters.
3230 \let\{ = \mylbrace
3231 \let\} = \myrbrace
3232 %
3233 % Do the redefinitions.
3234 \commondummies
3235 }
3236
3237 % For the aux and toc files, @ is the escape character. So we want to
3238 % redefine everything using @ as the escape character (instead of
3239 % \realbackslash, still used for index files). When everything uses @,
3240 % this will be simpler.
3241 %
3242 \def\atdummies{%
3243 \def\@{@@}%
3244 \def\ {@ }%
3245 \let\{ = \lbraceatcmd
3246 \let\} = \rbraceatcmd
3247 %
3248 % Do the redefinitions.
3249 \commondummies
3250 \otherbackslash
3251 }
3252
3253 % Called from \indexdummies and \atdummies.
3254 %
3255 \def\commondummies{%
3256 %
3257 % \definedummyword defines \#1 as \string\#1\space, thus effectively
3258 % preventing its expansion. This is used only for control% words,
3259 % not control letters, because the \space would be incorrect for
3260 % control characters, but is needed to separate the control word
3261 % from whatever follows.
3262 %
3263 % For control letters, we have \definedummyletter, which omits the
3264 % space.
3265 %
3266 % These can be used both for control words that take an argument and
3267 % those that do not. If it is followed by {arg} in the input, then
3268 % that will dutifully get written to the index (or wherever).
3269 %
3270 \def\definedummyword ##1{\def##1{\string##1\space}}%
3271 \def\definedummyletter##1{\def##1{\string##1}}%
3272 \let\definedummyaccent\definedummyletter
3273 %
3274 \commondummiesnofonts
3275 %
3276 \definedummyletter\_%
3277 %
3278 % Non-English letters.
3279 \definedummyword\AA
3280 \definedummyword\AE
3281 \definedummyword\L
3282 \definedummyword\OE
3283 \definedummyword\O
3284 \definedummyword\aa
3285 \definedummyword\ae
3286 \definedummyword\l
3287 \definedummyword\oe
3288 \definedummyword\o
3289 \definedummyword\ss
3290 \definedummyword\exclamdown
3291 \definedummyword\questiondown
3292 \definedummyword\ordf
3293 \definedummyword\ordm
3294 %
3295 % Although these internal commands shouldn't show up, sometimes they do.
3296 \definedummyword\bf
3297 \definedummyword\gtr
3298 \definedummyword\hat
3299 \definedummyword\less
3300 \definedummyword\sf
3301 \definedummyword\sl
3302 \definedummyword\tclose
3303 \definedummyword\tt
3304 %
3305 \definedummyword\LaTeX
3306 \definedummyword\TeX
3307 %
3308 % Assorted special characters.
3309 \definedummyword\bullet
3310 \definedummyword\comma
3311 \definedummyword\copyright
3312 \definedummyword\registeredsymbol
3313 \definedummyword\dots
3314 \definedummyword\enddots
3315 \definedummyword\equiv
3316 \definedummyword\error
3317 \definedummyword\euro
3318 \definedummyword\expansion
3319 \definedummyword\minus
3320 \definedummyword\pounds
3321 \definedummyword\point
3322 \definedummyword\print
3323 \definedummyword\result
3324 %
3325 % We want to disable all macros so that they are not expanded by \write.
3326 \macrolist
3327 %
3328 \normalturnoffactive
3329 %
3330 % Handle some cases of @value -- where it does not contain any
3331 % (non-fully-expandable) commands.
3332 \makevalueexpandable
3333 }
3334
3335 % \commondummiesnofonts: common to \commondummies and \indexnofonts.
3336 %
3337 \def\commondummiesnofonts{%
3338 % Control letters and accents.
3339 \definedummyletter\!%
3340 \definedummyaccent\"%
3341 \definedummyaccent\'%
3342 \definedummyletter\*%
3343 \definedummyaccent\,%
3344 \definedummyletter\.%
3345 \definedummyletter\/%
3346 \definedummyletter\:%
3347 \definedummyaccent\=%
3348 \definedummyletter\?%
3349 \definedummyaccent\^%
3350 \definedummyaccent\`%
3351 \definedummyaccent\~%
3352 \definedummyword\u
3353 \definedummyword\v
3354 \definedummyword\H
3355 \definedummyword\dotaccent
3356 \definedummyword\ringaccent
3357 \definedummyword\tieaccent
3358 \definedummyword\ubaraccent
3359 \definedummyword\udotaccent
3360 \definedummyword\dotless
3361 %
3362 % Texinfo font commands.
3363 \definedummyword\b
3364 \definedummyword\i
3365 \definedummyword\r
3366 \definedummyword\sc
3367 \definedummyword\t
3368 %
3369 % Commands that take arguments.
3370 \definedummyword\acronym
3371 \definedummyword\cite
3372 \definedummyword\code
3373 \definedummyword\command
3374 \definedummyword\dfn
3375 \definedummyword\emph
3376 \definedummyword\env
3377 \definedummyword\file
3378 \definedummyword\kbd
3379 \definedummyword\key
3380 \definedummyword\math
3381 \definedummyword\option
3382 \definedummyword\pxref
3383 \definedummyword\ref
3384 \definedummyword\samp
3385 \definedummyword\strong
3386 \definedummyword\tie
3387 \definedummyword\uref
3388 \definedummyword\url
3389 \definedummyword\var
3390 \definedummyword\verb
3391 \definedummyword\w
3392 \definedummyword\xref
3393 }
3394
3395 % \indexnofonts is used when outputting the strings to sort the index
3396 % by, and when constructing control sequence names. It eliminates all
3397 % control sequences and just writes whatever the best ASCII sort string
3398 % would be for a given command (usually its argument).
3399 %
3400 \def\indexnofonts{%
3401 % Accent commands should become @asis.
3402 \def\definedummyaccent##1{\let##1\asis}%
3403 % We can just ignore other control letters.
3404 \def\definedummyletter##1{\let##1\empty}%
3405 % Hopefully, all control words can become @asis.
3406 \let\definedummyword\definedummyaccent
3407 %
3408 \commondummiesnofonts
3409 %
3410 % Don't no-op \tt, since it isn't a user-level command
3411 % and is used in the definitions of the active chars like <, >, |, etc.
3412 % Likewise with the other plain tex font commands.
3413 %\let\tt=\asis
3414 %
3415 \def\ { }%
3416 \def\@{@}%
3417 % how to handle braces?
3418 \def\_{\normalunderscore}%
3419 %
3420 % Non-English letters.
3421 \def\AA{AA}%
3422 \def\AE{AE}%
3423 \def\L{L}%
3424 \def\OE{OE}%
3425 \def\O{O}%
3426 \def\aa{aa}%
3427 \def\ae{ae}%
3428 \def\l{l}%
3429 \def\oe{oe}%
3430 \def\o{o}%
3431 \def\ss{ss}%
3432 \def\exclamdown{!}%
3433 \def\questiondown{?}%
3434 \def\ordf{a}%
3435 \def\ordm{o}%
3436 %
3437 \def\LaTeX{LaTeX}%
3438 \def\TeX{TeX}%
3439 %
3440 % Assorted special characters.
3441 % (The following {} will end up in the sort string, but that's ok.)
3442 \def\bullet{bullet}%
3443 \def\comma{,}%
3444 \def\copyright{copyright}%
3445 \def\registeredsymbol{R}%
3446 \def\dots{...}%
3447 \def\enddots{...}%
3448 \def\equiv{==}%
3449 \def\error{error}%
3450 \def\euro{euro}%
3451 \def\expansion{==>}%
3452 \def\minus{-}%
3453 \def\pounds{pounds}%
3454 \def\point{.}%
3455 \def\print{-|}%
3456 \def\result{=>}%
3457 %
3458 % We need to get rid of all macros, leaving only the arguments (if present).
3459 % Of course this is not nearly correct, but it is the best we can do for now.
3460 % makeinfo does not expand macros in the argument to @deffn, which ends up
3461 % writing an index entry, and texindex isn't prepared for an index sort entry
3462 % that starts with \.
3463 %
3464 % Since macro invocations are followed by braces, we can just redefine them
3465 % to take a single TeX argument. The case of a macro invocation that
3466 % goes to end-of-line is not handled.
3467 %
3468 \macrolist
3469 }
3470
3471 \let\indexbackslash=0 %overridden during \printindex.
3472 \let\SETmarginindex=\relax % put index entries in margin (undocumented)?
3473
3474 % Most index entries go through here, but \dosubind is the general case.
3475 % #1 is the index name, #2 is the entry text.
3476 \def\doind#1#2{\dosubind{#1}{#2}{}}
3477
3478 % Workhorse for all \fooindexes.
3479 % #1 is name of index, #2 is stuff to put there, #3 is subentry --
3480 % empty if called from \doind, as we usually are (the main exception
3481 % is with most defuns, which call us directly).
3482 %
3483 \def\dosubind#1#2#3{%
3484 \iflinks
3485 {%
3486 % Store the main index entry text (including the third arg).
3487 \toks0 = {#2}%
3488 % If third arg is present, precede it with a space.
3489 \def\thirdarg{#3}%
3490 \ifx\thirdarg\empty \else
3491 \toks0 = \expandafter{\the\toks0 \space #3}%
3492 \fi
3493 %
3494 \edef\writeto{\csname#1indfile\endcsname}%
3495 %
3496 \ifvmode
3497 \dosubindsanitize
3498 \else
3499 \dosubindwrite
3500 \fi
3501 }%
3502 \fi
3503 }
3504
3505 % Write the entry in \toks0 to the index file:
3506 %
3507 \def\dosubindwrite{%
3508 % Put the index entry in the margin if desired.
3509 \ifx\SETmarginindex\relax\else
3510 \insert\margin{\hbox{\vrule height8pt depth3pt width0pt \the\toks0}}%
3511 \fi
3512 %
3513 % Remember, we are within a group.
3514 \indexdummies % Must do this here, since \bf, etc expand at this stage
3515 \def\backslashcurfont{\indexbackslash}% \indexbackslash isn't defined now
3516 % so it will be output as is; and it will print as backslash.
3517 %
3518 % Process the index entry with all font commands turned off, to
3519 % get the string to sort by.
3520 {\indexnofonts
3521 \edef\temp{\the\toks0}% need full expansion
3522 \xdef\indexsorttmp{\temp}%
3523 }%
3524 %
3525 % Set up the complete index entry, with both the sort key and
3526 % the original text, including any font commands. We write
3527 % three arguments to \entry to the .?? file (four in the
3528 % subentry case), texindex reduces to two when writing the .??s
3529 % sorted result.
3530 \edef\temp{%
3531 \write\writeto{%
3532 \string\entry{\indexsorttmp}{\noexpand\folio}{\the\toks0}}%
3533 }%
3534 \temp
3535 }
3536
3537 % Take care of unwanted page breaks:
3538 %
3539 % If a skip is the last thing on the list now, preserve it
3540 % by backing up by \lastskip, doing the \write, then inserting
3541 % the skip again. Otherwise, the whatsit generated by the
3542 % \write will make \lastskip zero. The result is that sequences
3543 % like this:
3544 % @end defun
3545 % @tindex whatever
3546 % @defun ...
3547 % will have extra space inserted, because the \medbreak in the
3548 % start of the @defun won't see the skip inserted by the @end of
3549 % the previous defun.
3550 %
3551 % But don't do any of this if we're not in vertical mode. We
3552 % don't want to do a \vskip and prematurely end a paragraph.
3553 %
3554 % Avoid page breaks due to these extra skips, too.
3555 %
3556 % But wait, there is a catch there:
3557 % We'll have to check whether \lastskip is zero skip. \ifdim is not
3558 % sufficient for this purpose, as it ignores stretch and shrink parts
3559 % of the skip. The only way seems to be to check the textual
3560 % representation of the skip.
3561 %
3562 % The following is almost like \def\zeroskipmacro{0.0pt} except that
3563 % the ``p'' and ``t'' characters have catcode \other, not 11 (letter).
3564 %
3565 \edef\zeroskipmacro{\expandafter\the\csname z@skip\endcsname}
3566 %
3567 % ..., ready, GO:
3568 %
3569 \def\dosubindsanitize{%
3570 % \lastskip and \lastpenalty cannot both be nonzero simultaneously.
3571 \skip0 = \lastskip
3572 \edef\lastskipmacro{\the\lastskip}%
3573 \count255 = \lastpenalty
3574 %
3575 % If \lastskip is nonzero, that means the last item was a
3576 % skip. And since a skip is discardable, that means this
3577 % -\skip0 glue we're inserting is preceded by a
3578 % non-discardable item, therefore it is not a potential
3579 % breakpoint, therefore no \nobreak needed.
3580 \ifx\lastskipmacro\zeroskipmacro
3581 \else
3582 \vskip-\skip0
3583 \fi
3584 %
3585 \dosubindwrite
3586 %
3587 \ifx\lastskipmacro\zeroskipmacro
3588 % If \lastskip was zero, perhaps the last item was a penalty, and
3589 % perhaps it was >=10000, e.g., a \nobreak. In that case, we want
3590 % to re-insert the same penalty (values >10000 are used for various
3591 % signals); since we just inserted a non-discardable item, any
3592 % following glue (such as a \parskip) would be a breakpoint. For example:
3593 %
3594 % @deffn deffn-whatever
3595 % @vindex index-whatever
3596 % Description.
3597 % would allow a break between the index-whatever whatsit
3598 % and the "Description." paragraph.
3599 \ifnum\count255>9999 \penalty\count255 \fi
3600 \else
3601 % On the other hand, if we had a nonzero \lastskip,
3602 % this make-up glue would be preceded by a non-discardable item
3603 % (the whatsit from the \write), so we must insert a \nobreak.
3604 \nobreak\vskip\skip0
3605 \fi
3606 }
3607
3608 % The index entry written in the file actually looks like
3609 % \entry {sortstring}{page}{topic}
3610 % or
3611 % \entry {sortstring}{page}{topic}{subtopic}
3612 % The texindex program reads in these files and writes files
3613 % containing these kinds of lines:
3614 % \initial {c}
3615 % before the first topic whose initial is c
3616 % \entry {topic}{pagelist}
3617 % for a topic that is used without subtopics
3618 % \primary {topic}
3619 % for the beginning of a topic that is used with subtopics
3620 % \secondary {subtopic}{pagelist}
3621 % for each subtopic.
3622
3623 % Define the user-accessible indexing commands
3624 % @findex, @vindex, @kindex, @cindex.
3625
3626 \def\findex {\fnindex}
3627 \def\kindex {\kyindex}
3628 \def\cindex {\cpindex}
3629 \def\vindex {\vrindex}
3630 \def\tindex {\tpindex}
3631 \def\pindex {\pgindex}
3632
3633 \def\cindexsub {\begingroup\obeylines\cindexsub}
3634 {\obeylines %
3635 \gdef\cindexsub "#1" #2^^M{\endgroup %
3636 \dosubind{cp}{#2}{#1}}}
3637
3638 % Define the macros used in formatting output of the sorted index material.
3639
3640 % @printindex causes a particular index (the ??s file) to get printed.
3641 % It does not print any chapter heading (usually an @unnumbered).
3642 %
3643 \parseargdef\printindex{\begingroup
3644 \dobreak \chapheadingskip{10000}%
3645 %
3646 \smallfonts \rm
3647 \tolerance = 9500
3648 \everypar = {}% don't want the \kern\-parindent from indentation suppression.
3649 %
3650 % See if the index file exists and is nonempty.
3651 % Change catcode of @ here so that if the index file contains
3652 % \initial {@}
3653 % as its first line, TeX doesn't complain about mismatched braces
3654 % (because it thinks @} is a control sequence).
3655 \catcode`\@ = 11
3656 \openin 1 \jobname.#1s
3657 \ifeof 1
3658 % \enddoublecolumns gets confused if there is no text in the index,
3659 % and it loses the chapter title and the aux file entries for the
3660 % index. The easiest way to prevent this problem is to make sure
3661 % there is some text.
3662 \putwordIndexNonexistent
3663 \else
3664 %
3665 % If the index file exists but is empty, then \openin leaves \ifeof
3666 % false. We have to make TeX try to read something from the file, so
3667 % it can discover if there is anything in it.
3668 \read 1 to \temp
3669 \ifeof 1
3670 \putwordIndexIsEmpty
3671 \else
3672 % Index files are almost Texinfo source, but we use \ as the escape
3673 % character. It would be better to use @, but that's too big a change
3674 % to make right now.
3675 \def\indexbackslash{\backslashcurfont}%
3676 \catcode`\\ = 0
3677 \escapechar = `\\
3678 \begindoublecolumns
3679 \input \jobname.#1s
3680 \enddoublecolumns
3681 \fi
3682 \fi
3683 \closein 1
3684 \endgroup}
3685
3686 % These macros are used by the sorted index file itself.
3687 % Change them to control the appearance of the index.
3688
3689 \def\initial#1{{%
3690 % Some minor font changes for the special characters.
3691 \let\tentt=\sectt \let\tt=\sectt \let\sf=\sectt
3692 %
3693 % Remove any glue we may have, we'll be inserting our own.
3694 \removelastskip
3695 %
3696 % We like breaks before the index initials, so insert a bonus.
3697 \nobreak
3698 \vskip 0pt plus 3\baselineskip
3699 \penalty 0
3700 \vskip 0pt plus -3\baselineskip
3701 %
3702 % Typeset the initial. Making this add up to a whole number of
3703 % baselineskips increases the chance of the dots lining up from column
3704 % to column. It still won't often be perfect, because of the stretch
3705 % we need before each entry, but it's better.
3706 %
3707 % No shrink because it confuses \balancecolumns.
3708 \vskip 1.67\baselineskip plus .5\baselineskip
3709 \leftline{\secbf #1}%
3710 % Do our best not to break after the initial.
3711 \nobreak
3712 \vskip .33\baselineskip plus .1\baselineskip
3713 }}
3714
3715 % \entry typesets a paragraph consisting of the text (#1), dot leaders, and
3716 % then page number (#2) flushed to the right margin. It is used for index
3717 % and table of contents entries. The paragraph is indented by \leftskip.
3718 %
3719 % A straightforward implementation would start like this:
3720 % \def\entry#1#2{...
3721 % But this frozes the catcodes in the argument, and can cause problems to
3722 % @code, which sets - active. This problem was fixed by a kludge---
3723 % ``-'' was active throughout whole index, but this isn't really right.
3724 %
3725 % The right solution is to prevent \entry from swallowing the whole text.
3726 % --kasal, 21nov03
3727 \def\entry{%
3728 \begingroup
3729 %
3730 % Start a new paragraph if necessary, so our assignments below can't
3731 % affect previous text.
3732 \par
3733 %
3734 % Do not fill out the last line with white space.
3735 \parfillskip = 0in
3736 %
3737 % No extra space above this paragraph.
3738 \parskip = 0in
3739 %
3740 % Do not prefer a separate line ending with a hyphen to fewer lines.
3741 \finalhyphendemerits = 0
3742 %
3743 % \hangindent is only relevant when the entry text and page number
3744 % don't both fit on one line. In that case, bob suggests starting the
3745 % dots pretty far over on the line. Unfortunately, a large
3746 % indentation looks wrong when the entry text itself is broken across
3747 % lines. So we use a small indentation and put up with long leaders.
3748 %
3749 % \hangafter is reset to 1 (which is the value we want) at the start
3750 % of each paragraph, so we need not do anything with that.
3751 \hangindent = 2em
3752 %
3753 % When the entry text needs to be broken, just fill out the first line
3754 % with blank space.
3755 \rightskip = 0pt plus1fil
3756 %
3757 % A bit of stretch before each entry for the benefit of balancing
3758 % columns.
3759 \vskip 0pt plus1pt
3760 %
3761 % Swallow the left brace of the text (first parameter):
3762 \afterassignment\doentry
3763 \let\temp =
3764 }
3765 \def\doentry{%
3766 \bgroup % Instead of the swallowed brace.
3767 \noindent
3768 \aftergroup\finishentry
3769 % And now comes the text of the entry.
3770 }
3771 \def\finishentry#1{%
3772 % #1 is the page number.
3773 %
3774 % The following is kludged to not output a line of dots in the index if
3775 % there are no page numbers. The next person who breaks this will be
3776 % cursed by a Unix daemon.
3777 \def\tempa{{\rm }}%
3778 \def\tempb{#1}%
3779 \edef\tempc{\tempa}%
3780 \edef\tempd{\tempb}%
3781 \ifx\tempc\tempd
3782 \ %
3783 \else
3784 %
3785 % If we must, put the page number on a line of its own, and fill out
3786 % this line with blank space. (The \hfil is overwhelmed with the
3787 % fill leaders glue in \indexdotfill if the page number does fit.)
3788 \hfil\penalty50
3789 \null\nobreak\indexdotfill % Have leaders before the page number.
3790 %
3791 % The `\ ' here is removed by the implicit \unskip that TeX does as
3792 % part of (the primitive) \par. Without it, a spurious underfull
3793 % \hbox ensues.
3794 \ifpdf
3795 \pdfgettoks#1.%
3796 \ \the\toksA
3797 \else
3798 \ #1%
3799 \fi
3800 \fi
3801 \par
3802 \endgroup
3803 }
3804
3805 % Like \dotfill except takes at least 1 em.
3806 \def\indexdotfill{\cleaders
3807 \hbox{$\mathsurround=0pt \mkern1.5mu ${\it .}$ \mkern1.5mu$}\hskip 1em plus 1fill}
3808
3809 \def\primary #1{\line{#1\hfil}}
3810
3811 \newskip\secondaryindent \secondaryindent=0.5cm
3812 \def\secondary#1#2{{%
3813 \parfillskip=0in
3814 \parskip=0in
3815 \hangindent=1in
3816 \hangafter=1
3817 \noindent\hskip\secondaryindent\hbox{#1}\indexdotfill
3818 \ifpdf
3819 \pdfgettoks#2.\ \the\toksA % The page number ends the paragraph.
3820 \else
3821 #2
3822 \fi
3823 \par
3824 }}
3825
3826 % Define two-column mode, which we use to typeset indexes.
3827 % Adapted from the TeXbook, page 416, which is to say,
3828 % the manmac.tex format used to print the TeXbook itself.
3829 \catcode`\@=11
3830
3831 \newbox\partialpage
3832 \newdimen\doublecolumnhsize
3833
3834 \def\begindoublecolumns{\begingroup % ended by \enddoublecolumns
3835 % Grab any single-column material above us.
3836 \output = {%
3837 %
3838 % Here is a possibility not foreseen in manmac: if we accumulate a
3839 % whole lot of material, we might end up calling this \output
3840 % routine twice in a row (see the doublecol-lose test, which is
3841 % essentially a couple of indexes with @setchapternewpage off). In
3842 % that case we just ship out what is in \partialpage with the normal
3843 % output routine. Generally, \partialpage will be empty when this
3844 % runs and this will be a no-op. See the indexspread.tex test case.
3845 \ifvoid\partialpage \else
3846 \onepageout{\pagecontents\partialpage}%
3847 \fi
3848 %
3849 \global\setbox\partialpage = \vbox{%
3850 % Unvbox the main output page.
3851 \unvbox\PAGE
3852 \kern-\topskip \kern\baselineskip
3853 }%
3854 }%
3855 \eject % run that output routine to set \partialpage
3856 %
3857 % Use the double-column output routine for subsequent pages.
3858 \output = {\doublecolumnout}%
3859 %
3860 % Change the page size parameters. We could do this once outside this
3861 % routine, in each of @smallbook, @afourpaper, and the default 8.5x11
3862 % format, but then we repeat the same computation. Repeating a couple
3863 % of assignments once per index is clearly meaningless for the
3864 % execution time, so we may as well do it in one place.
3865 %
3866 % First we halve the line length, less a little for the gutter between
3867 % the columns. We compute the gutter based on the line length, so it
3868 % changes automatically with the paper format. The magic constant
3869 % below is chosen so that the gutter has the same value (well, +-<1pt)
3870 % as it did when we hard-coded it.
3871 %
3872 % We put the result in a separate register, \doublecolumhsize, so we
3873 % can restore it in \pagesofar, after \hsize itself has (potentially)
3874 % been clobbered.
3875 %
3876 \doublecolumnhsize = \hsize
3877 \advance\doublecolumnhsize by -.04154\hsize
3878 \divide\doublecolumnhsize by 2
3879 \hsize = \doublecolumnhsize
3880 %
3881 % Double the \vsize as well. (We don't need a separate register here,
3882 % since nobody clobbers \vsize.)
3883 \vsize = 2\vsize
3884 }
3885
3886 % The double-column output routine for all double-column pages except
3887 % the last.
3888 %
3889 \def\doublecolumnout{%
3890 \splittopskip=\topskip \splitmaxdepth=\maxdepth
3891 % Get the available space for the double columns -- the normal
3892 % (undoubled) page height minus any material left over from the
3893 % previous page.
3894 \dimen@ = \vsize
3895 \divide\dimen@ by 2
3896 \advance\dimen@ by -\ht\partialpage
3897 %
3898 % box0 will be the left-hand column, box2 the right.
3899 \setbox0=\vsplit255 to\dimen@ \setbox2=\vsplit255 to\dimen@
3900 \onepageout\pagesofar
3901 \unvbox255
3902 \penalty\outputpenalty
3903 }
3904 %
3905 % Re-output the contents of the output page -- any previous material,
3906 % followed by the two boxes we just split, in box0 and box2.
3907 \def\pagesofar{%
3908 \unvbox\partialpage
3909 %
3910 \hsize = \doublecolumnhsize
3911 \wd0=\hsize \wd2=\hsize
3912 \hbox to\pagewidth{\box0\hfil\box2}%
3913 }
3914 %
3915 % All done with double columns.
3916 \def\enddoublecolumns{%
3917 \output = {%
3918 % Split the last of the double-column material. Leave it on the
3919 % current page, no automatic page break.
3920 \balancecolumns
3921 %
3922 % If we end up splitting too much material for the current page,
3923 % though, there will be another page break right after this \output
3924 % invocation ends. Having called \balancecolumns once, we do not
3925 % want to call it again. Therefore, reset \output to its normal
3926 % definition right away. (We hope \balancecolumns will never be
3927 % called on to balance too much material, but if it is, this makes
3928 % the output somewhat more palatable.)
3929 \global\output = {\onepageout{\pagecontents\PAGE}}%
3930 }%
3931 \eject
3932 \endgroup % started in \begindoublecolumns
3933 %
3934 % \pagegoal was set to the doubled \vsize above, since we restarted
3935 % the current page. We're now back to normal single-column
3936 % typesetting, so reset \pagegoal to the normal \vsize (after the
3937 % \endgroup where \vsize got restored).
3938 \pagegoal = \vsize
3939 }
3940 %
3941 % Called at the end of the double column material.
3942 \def\balancecolumns{%
3943 \setbox0 = \vbox{\unvbox255}% like \box255 but more efficient, see p.120.
3944 \dimen@ = \ht0
3945 \advance\dimen@ by \topskip
3946 \advance\dimen@ by-\baselineskip
3947 \divide\dimen@ by 2 % target to split to
3948 %debug\message{final 2-column material height=\the\ht0, target=\the\dimen@.}%
3949 \splittopskip = \topskip
3950 % Loop until we get a decent breakpoint.
3951 {%
3952 \vbadness = 10000
3953 \loop
3954 \global\setbox3 = \copy0
3955 \global\setbox1 = \vsplit3 to \dimen@
3956 \ifdim\ht3>\dimen@
3957 \global\advance\dimen@ by 1pt
3958 \repeat
3959 }%
3960 %debug\message{split to \the\dimen@, column heights: \the\ht1, \the\ht3.}%
3961 \setbox0=\vbox to\dimen@{\unvbox1}%
3962 \setbox2=\vbox to\dimen@{\unvbox3}%
3963 %
3964 \pagesofar
3965 }
3966 \catcode`\@ = \other
3967
3968
3969 \message{sectioning,}
3970 % Chapters, sections, etc.
3971
3972 % \unnumberedno is an oxymoron, of course. But we count the unnumbered
3973 % sections so that we can refer to them unambiguously in the pdf
3974 % outlines by their "section number". We avoid collisions with chapter
3975 % numbers by starting them at 10000. (If a document ever has 10000
3976 % chapters, we're in trouble anyway, I'm sure.)
3977 \newcount\unnumberedno \unnumberedno = 10000
3978 \newcount\chapno
3979 \newcount\secno \secno=0
3980 \newcount\subsecno \subsecno=0
3981 \newcount\subsubsecno \subsubsecno=0
3982
3983 % This counter is funny since it counts through charcodes of letters A, B, ...
3984 \newcount\appendixno \appendixno = `\@
3985 %
3986 % \def\appendixletter{\char\the\appendixno}
3987 % We do the following ugly conditional instead of the above simple
3988 % construct for the sake of pdftex, which needs the actual
3989 % letter in the expansion, not just typeset.
3990 %
3991 \def\appendixletter{%
3992 \ifnum\appendixno=`A A%
3993 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`B B%
3994 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`C C%
3995 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`D D%
3996 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`E E%
3997 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`F F%
3998 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`G G%
3999 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`H H%
4000 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`I I%
4001 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`J J%
4002 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`K K%
4003 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`L L%
4004 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`M M%
4005 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`N N%
4006 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`O O%
4007 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`P P%
4008 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Q Q%
4009 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`R R%
4010 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`S S%
4011 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`T T%
4012 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`U U%
4013 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`V V%
4014 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`W W%
4015 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`X X%
4016 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Y Y%
4017 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Z Z%
4018 % The \the is necessary, despite appearances, because \appendixletter is
4019 % expanded while writing the .toc file. \char\appendixno is not
4020 % expandable, thus it is written literally, thus all appendixes come out
4021 % with the same letter (or @) in the toc without it.
4022 \else\char\the\appendixno
4023 \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi
4024 \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi}
4025
4026 % Each @chapter defines this as the name of the chapter.
4027 % page headings and footings can use it. @section does likewise.
4028 % However, they are not reliable, because we don't use marks.
4029 \def\thischapter{}
4030 \def\thissection{}
4031
4032 \newcount\absseclevel % used to calculate proper heading level
4033 \newcount\secbase\secbase=0 % @raisesections/@lowersections modify this count
4034
4035 % @raisesections: treat @section as chapter, @subsection as section, etc.
4036 \def\raisesections{\global\advance\secbase by -1}
4037 \let\up=\raisesections % original BFox name
4038
4039 % @lowersections: treat @chapter as section, @section as subsection, etc.
4040 \def\lowersections{\global\advance\secbase by 1}
4041 \let\down=\lowersections % original BFox name
4042
4043 % we only have subsub.
4044 \chardef\maxseclevel = 3
4045 %
4046 % A numbered section within an unnumbered changes to unnumbered too.
4047 % To achive this, remember the "biggest" unnum. sec. we are currently in:
4048 \chardef\unmlevel = \maxseclevel
4049 %
4050 % Trace whether the current chapter is an appendix or not:
4051 % \chapheadtype is "N" or "A", unnumbered chapters are ignored.
4052 \def\chapheadtype{N}
4053
4054 % Choose a heading macro
4055 % #1 is heading type
4056 % #2 is heading level
4057 % #3 is text for heading
4058 \def\genhead#1#2#3{%
4059 % Compute the abs. sec. level:
4060 \absseclevel=#2
4061 \advance\absseclevel by \secbase
4062 % Make sure \absseclevel doesn't fall outside the range:
4063 \ifnum \absseclevel < 0
4064 \absseclevel = 0
4065 \else
4066 \ifnum \absseclevel > 3
4067 \absseclevel = 3
4068 \fi
4069 \fi
4070 % The heading type:
4071 \def\headtype{#1}%
4072 \if \headtype U%
4073 \ifnum \absseclevel < \unmlevel
4074 \chardef\unmlevel = \absseclevel
4075 \fi
4076 \else
4077 % Check for appendix sections:
4078 \ifnum \absseclevel = 0
4079 \edef\chapheadtype{\headtype}%
4080 \else
4081 \if \headtype A\if \chapheadtype N%
4082 \errmessage{@appendix... within a non-appendix chapter}%
4083 \fi\fi
4084 \fi
4085 % Check for numbered within unnumbered:
4086 \ifnum \absseclevel > \unmlevel
4087 \def\headtype{U}%
4088 \else
4089 \chardef\unmlevel = 3
4090 \fi
4091 \fi
4092 % Now print the heading:
4093 \if \headtype U%
4094 \ifcase\absseclevel
4095 \unnumberedzzz{#3}%
4096 \or \unnumberedseczzz{#3}%
4097 \or \unnumberedsubseczzz{#3}%
4098 \or \unnumberedsubsubseczzz{#3}%
4099 \fi
4100 \else
4101 \if \headtype A%
4102 \ifcase\absseclevel
4103 \appendixzzz{#3}%
4104 \or \appendixsectionzzz{#3}%
4105 \or \appendixsubseczzz{#3}%
4106 \or \appendixsubsubseczzz{#3}%
4107 \fi
4108 \else
4109 \ifcase\absseclevel
4110 \chapterzzz{#3}%
4111 \or \seczzz{#3}%
4112 \or \numberedsubseczzz{#3}%
4113 \or \numberedsubsubseczzz{#3}%
4114 \fi
4115 \fi
4116 \fi
4117 \suppressfirstparagraphindent
4118 }
4119
4120 % an interface:
4121 \def\numhead{\genhead N}
4122 \def\apphead{\genhead A}
4123 \def\unnmhead{\genhead U}
4124
4125 % @chapter, @appendix, @unnumbered. Increment top-level counter, reset
4126 % all lower-level sectioning counters to zero.
4127 %
4128 % Also set \chaplevelprefix, which we prepend to @float sequence numbers
4129 % (e.g., figures), q.v. By default (before any chapter), that is empty.
4130 \let\chaplevelprefix = \empty
4131 %
4132 \outer\parseargdef\chapter{\numhead0{#1}} % normally numhead0 calls chapterzzz
4133 \def\chapterzzz#1{%
4134 % section resetting is \global in case the chapter is in a group, such
4135 % as an @include file.
4136 \global\secno=0 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0
4137 \global\advance\chapno by 1
4138 %
4139 % Used for \float.
4140 \gdef\chaplevelprefix{\the\chapno.}%
4141 \resetallfloatnos
4142 %
4143 \message{\putwordChapter\space \the\chapno}%
4144 %
4145 % Write the actual heading.
4146 \chapmacro{#1}{Ynumbered}{\the\chapno}%
4147 %
4148 % So @section and the like are numbered underneath this chapter.
4149 \global\let\section = \numberedsec
4150 \global\let\subsection = \numberedsubsec
4151 \global\let\subsubsection = \numberedsubsubsec
4152 }
4153
4154 \outer\parseargdef\appendix{\apphead0{#1}} % normally apphead0 calls appendixzzz
4155 \def\appendixzzz#1{%
4156 \global\secno=0 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0
4157 \global\advance\appendixno by 1
4158 \gdef\chaplevelprefix{\appendixletter.}%
4159 \resetallfloatnos
4160 %
4161 \def\appendixnum{\putwordAppendix\space \appendixletter}%
4162 \message{\appendixnum}%
4163 %
4164 \chapmacro{#1}{Yappendix}{\appendixletter}%
4165 %
4166 \global\let\section = \appendixsec
4167 \global\let\subsection = \appendixsubsec
4168 \global\let\subsubsection = \appendixsubsubsec
4169 }
4170
4171 \outer\parseargdef\unnumbered{\unnmhead0{#1}} % normally unnmhead0 calls unnumberedzzz
4172 \def\unnumberedzzz#1{%
4173 \global\secno=0 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0
4174 \global\advance\unnumberedno by 1
4175 %
4176 % Since an unnumbered has no number, no prefix for figures.
4177 \global\let\chaplevelprefix = \empty
4178 \resetallfloatnos
4179 %
4180 % This used to be simply \message{#1}, but TeX fully expands the
4181 % argument to \message. Therefore, if #1 contained @-commands, TeX
4182 % expanded them. For example, in `@unnumbered The @cite{Book}', TeX
4183 % expanded @cite (which turns out to cause errors because \cite is meant
4184 % to be executed, not expanded).
4185 %
4186 % Anyway, we don't want the fully-expanded definition of @cite to appear
4187 % as a result of the \message, we just want `@cite' itself. We use
4188 % \the<toks register> to achieve this: TeX expands \the<toks> only once,
4189 % simply yielding the contents of <toks register>. (We also do this for
4190 % the toc entries.)
4191 \toks0 = {#1}%
4192 \message{(\the\toks0)}%
4193 %
4194 \chapmacro{#1}{Ynothing}{\the\unnumberedno}%
4195 %
4196 \global\let\section = \unnumberedsec
4197 \global\let\subsection = \unnumberedsubsec
4198 \global\let\subsubsection = \unnumberedsubsubsec
4199 }
4200
4201 % @centerchap is like @unnumbered, but the heading is centered.
4202 \outer\parseargdef\centerchap{%
4203 % Well, we could do the following in a group, but that would break
4204 % an assumption that \chapmacro is called at the outermost level.
4205 % Thus we are safer this way: --kasal, 24feb04
4206 \let\centerparametersmaybe = \centerparameters
4207 \unnmhead0{#1}%
4208 \let\centerparametersmaybe = \relax
4209 }
4210
4211 % @top is like @unnumbered.
4212 \let\top\unnumbered
4213
4214 % Sections.
4215 \outer\parseargdef\numberedsec{\numhead1{#1}} % normally calls seczzz
4216 \def\seczzz#1{%
4217 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\secno by 1
4218 \sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Ynumbered}{\the\chapno.\the\secno}%
4219 }
4220
4221 \outer\parseargdef\appendixsection{\apphead1{#1}} % normally calls appendixsectionzzz
4222 \def\appendixsectionzzz#1{%
4223 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\secno by 1
4224 \sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Yappendix}{\appendixletter.\the\secno}%
4225 }
4226 \let\appendixsec\appendixsection
4227
4228 \outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsec{\unnmhead1{#1}} % normally calls unnumberedseczzz
4229 \def\unnumberedseczzz#1{%
4230 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\secno by 1
4231 \sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Ynothing}{\the\unnumberedno.\the\secno}%
4232 }
4233
4234 % Subsections.
4235 \outer\parseargdef\numberedsubsec{\numhead2{#1}} % normally calls numberedsubseczzz
4236 \def\numberedsubseczzz#1{%
4237 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\subsecno by 1
4238 \sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Ynumbered}{\the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno}%
4239 }
4240
4241 \outer\parseargdef\appendixsubsec{\apphead2{#1}} % normally calls appendixsubseczzz
4242 \def\appendixsubseczzz#1{%
4243 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\subsecno by 1
4244 \sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Yappendix}%
4245 {\appendixletter.\the\secno.\the\subsecno}%
4246 }
4247
4248 \outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsubsec{\unnmhead2{#1}} %normally calls unnumberedsubseczzz
4249 \def\unnumberedsubseczzz#1{%
4250 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\subsecno by 1
4251 \sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Ynothing}%
4252 {\the\unnumberedno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno}%
4253 }
4254
4255 % Subsubsections.
4256 \outer\parseargdef\numberedsubsubsec{\numhead3{#1}} % normally numberedsubsubseczzz
4257 \def\numberedsubsubseczzz#1{%
4258 \global\advance\subsubsecno by 1
4259 \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Ynumbered}%
4260 {\the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno}%
4261 }
4262
4263 \outer\parseargdef\appendixsubsubsec{\apphead3{#1}} % normally appendixsubsubseczzz
4264 \def\appendixsubsubseczzz#1{%
4265 \global\advance\subsubsecno by 1
4266 \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Yappendix}%
4267 {\appendixletter.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno}%
4268 }
4269
4270 \outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsubsubsec{\unnmhead3{#1}} %normally unnumberedsubsubseczzz
4271 \def\unnumberedsubsubseczzz#1{%
4272 \global\advance\subsubsecno by 1
4273 \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Ynothing}%
4274 {\the\unnumberedno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno}%
4275 }
4276
4277 % These macros control what the section commands do, according
4278 % to what kind of chapter we are in (ordinary, appendix, or unnumbered).
4279 % Define them by default for a numbered chapter.
4280 \let\section = \numberedsec
4281 \let\subsection = \numberedsubsec
4282 \let\subsubsection = \numberedsubsubsec
4283
4284 % Define @majorheading, @heading and @subheading
4285
4286 % NOTE on use of \vbox for chapter headings, section headings, and such:
4287 % 1) We use \vbox rather than the earlier \line to permit
4288 % overlong headings to fold.
4289 % 2) \hyphenpenalty is set to 10000 because hyphenation in a
4290 % heading is obnoxious; this forbids it.
4291 % 3) Likewise, headings look best if no \parindent is used, and
4292 % if justification is not attempted. Hence \raggedright.
4293
4294
4295 \def\majorheading{%
4296 {\advance\chapheadingskip by 10pt \chapbreak }%
4297 \parsearg\chapheadingzzz
4298 }
4299
4300 \def\chapheading{\chapbreak \parsearg\chapheadingzzz}
4301 \def\chapheadingzzz#1{%
4302 {\chapfonts \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000\tolerance=5000
4303 \parindent=0pt\raggedright
4304 \rm #1\hfill}}%
4305 \bigskip \par\penalty 200\relax
4306 \suppressfirstparagraphindent
4307 }
4308
4309 % @heading, @subheading, @subsubheading.
4310 \parseargdef\heading{\sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Yomitfromtoc}{}
4311 \suppressfirstparagraphindent}
4312 \parseargdef\subheading{\sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Yomitfromtoc}{}
4313 \suppressfirstparagraphindent}
4314 \parseargdef\subsubheading{\sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Yomitfromtoc}{}
4315 \suppressfirstparagraphindent}
4316
4317 % These macros generate a chapter, section, etc. heading only
4318 % (including whitespace, linebreaking, etc. around it),
4319 % given all the information in convenient, parsed form.
4320
4321 %%% Args are the skip and penalty (usually negative)
4322 \def\dobreak#1#2{\par\ifdim\lastskip<#1\removelastskip\penalty#2\vskip#1\fi}
4323
4324 %%% Define plain chapter starts, and page on/off switching for it
4325 % Parameter controlling skip before chapter headings (if needed)
4326
4327 \newskip\chapheadingskip
4328
4329 \def\chapbreak{\dobreak \chapheadingskip {-4000}}
4330 \def\chappager{\par\vfill\supereject}
4331 \def\chapoddpage{\chappager \ifodd\pageno \else \hbox to 0pt{} \chappager\fi}
4332
4333 \def\setchapternewpage #1 {\csname CHAPPAG#1\endcsname}
4334
4335 \def\CHAPPAGoff{%
4336 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager
4337 \global\let\pchapsepmacro=\chapbreak
4338 \global\let\pagealignmacro=\chappager}
4339
4340 \def\CHAPPAGon{%
4341 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager
4342 \global\let\pchapsepmacro=\chappager
4343 \global\let\pagealignmacro=\chappager
4344 \global\def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSsingle}}
4345
4346 \def\CHAPPAGodd{%
4347 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chapoddpage
4348 \global\let\pchapsepmacro=\chapoddpage
4349 \global\let\pagealignmacro=\chapoddpage
4350 \global\def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSdouble}}
4351
4352 \CHAPPAGon
4353
4354 % Chapter opening.
4355 %
4356 % #1 is the text, #2 is the section type (Ynumbered, Ynothing,
4357 % Yappendix, Yomitfromtoc), #3 the chapter number.
4358 %
4359 % To test against our argument.
4360 \def\Ynothingkeyword{Ynothing}
4361 \def\Yomitfromtockeyword{Yomitfromtoc}
4362 \def\Yappendixkeyword{Yappendix}
4363 %
4364 \def\chapmacro#1#2#3{%
4365 \pchapsepmacro
4366 {%
4367 \chapfonts \rm
4368 %
4369 % Have to define \thissection before calling \donoderef, because the
4370 % xref code eventually uses it. On the other hand, it has to be called
4371 % after \pchapsepmacro, or the headline will change too soon.
4372 \gdef\thissection{#1}%
4373 \gdef\thischaptername{#1}%
4374 %
4375 % Only insert the separating space if we have a chapter/appendix
4376 % number, and don't print the unnumbered ``number''.
4377 \def\temptype{#2}%
4378 \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword
4379 \setbox0 = \hbox{}%
4380 \def\toctype{unnchap}%
4381 \gdef\thischapter{#1}%
4382 \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword
4383 \setbox0 = \hbox{}% contents like unnumbered, but no toc entry
4384 \def\toctype{omit}%
4385 \gdef\thischapter{}%
4386 \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword
4387 \setbox0 = \hbox{\putwordAppendix{} #3\enspace}%
4388 \def\toctype{app}%
4389 % We don't substitute the actual chapter name into \thischapter
4390 % because we don't want its macros evaluated now. And we don't
4391 % use \thissection because that changes with each section.
4392 %
4393 \xdef\thischapter{\putwordAppendix{} \appendixletter:
4394 \noexpand\thischaptername}%
4395 \else
4396 \setbox0 = \hbox{#3\enspace}%
4397 \def\toctype{numchap}%
4398 \xdef\thischapter{\putwordChapter{} \the\chapno:
4399 \noexpand\thischaptername}%
4400 \fi\fi\fi
4401 %
4402 % Write the toc entry for this chapter. Must come before the
4403 % \donoderef, because we include the current node name in the toc
4404 % entry, and \donoderef resets it to empty.
4405 \writetocentry{\toctype}{#1}{#3}%
4406 %
4407 % For pdftex, we have to write out the node definition (aka, make
4408 % the pdfdest) after any page break, but before the actual text has
4409 % been typeset. If the destination for the pdf outline is after the
4410 % text, then jumping from the outline may wind up with the text not
4411 % being visible, for instance under high magnification.
4412 \donoderef{#2}%
4413 %
4414 % Typeset the actual heading.
4415 \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000 \tolerance=5000 \parindent=0pt \raggedright
4416 \hangindent=\wd0 \centerparametersmaybe
4417 \unhbox0 #1\par}%
4418 }%
4419 \nobreak\bigskip % no page break after a chapter title
4420 \nobreak
4421 }
4422
4423 % @centerchap -- centered and unnumbered.
4424 \let\centerparametersmaybe = \relax
4425 \def\centerparameters{%
4426 \advance\rightskip by 3\rightskip
4427 \leftskip = \rightskip
4428 \parfillskip = 0pt
4429 }
4430
4431
4432 % I don't think this chapter style is supported any more, so I'm not
4433 % updating it with the new noderef stuff. We'll see. --karl, 11aug03.
4434 %
4435 \def\setchapterstyle #1 {\csname CHAPF#1\endcsname}
4436 %
4437 \def\unnchfopen #1{%
4438 \chapoddpage {\chapfonts \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000\tolerance=5000
4439 \parindent=0pt\raggedright
4440 \rm #1\hfill}}\bigskip \par\nobreak
4441 }
4442 \def\chfopen #1#2{\chapoddpage {\chapfonts
4443 \vbox to 3in{\vfil \hbox to\hsize{\hfil #2} \hbox to\hsize{\hfil #1} \vfil}}%
4444 \par\penalty 5000 %
4445 }
4446 \def\centerchfopen #1{%
4447 \chapoddpage {\chapfonts \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000\tolerance=5000
4448 \parindent=0pt
4449 \hfill {\rm #1}\hfill}}\bigskip \par\nobreak
4450 }
4451 \def\CHAPFopen{%
4452 \global\let\chapmacro=\chfopen
4453 \global\let\centerchapmacro=\centerchfopen}
4454
4455
4456 % Section titles. These macros combine the section number parts and
4457 % call the generic \sectionheading to do the printing.
4458 %
4459 \newskip\secheadingskip
4460 \def\secheadingbreak{\dobreak \secheadingskip{-1000}}
4461
4462 % Subsection titles.
4463 \newskip\subsecheadingskip
4464 \def\subsecheadingbreak{\dobreak \subsecheadingskip{-500}}
4465
4466 % Subsubsection titles.
4467 \def\subsubsecheadingskip{\subsecheadingskip}
4468 \def\subsubsecheadingbreak{\subsecheadingbreak}
4469
4470
4471 % Print any size, any type, section title.
4472 %
4473 % #1 is the text, #2 is the section level (sec/subsec/subsubsec), #3 is
4474 % the section type for xrefs (Ynumbered, Ynothing, Yappendix), #4 is the
4475 % section number.
4476 %
4477 \def\sectionheading#1#2#3#4{%
4478 {%
4479 % Switch to the right set of fonts.
4480 \csname #2fonts\endcsname \rm
4481 %
4482 % Insert space above the heading.
4483 \csname #2headingbreak\endcsname
4484 %
4485 % Only insert the space after the number if we have a section number.
4486 \def\sectionlevel{#2}%
4487 \def\temptype{#3}%
4488 %
4489 \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword
4490 \setbox0 = \hbox{}%
4491 \def\toctype{unn}%
4492 \gdef\thissection{#1}%
4493 \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword
4494 % for @headings -- no section number, don't include in toc,
4495 % and don't redefine \thissection.
4496 \setbox0 = \hbox{}%
4497 \def\toctype{omit}%
4498 \let\sectionlevel=\empty
4499 \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword
4500 \setbox0 = \hbox{#4\enspace}%
4501 \def\toctype{app}%
4502 \gdef\thissection{#1}%
4503 \else
4504 \setbox0 = \hbox{#4\enspace}%
4505 \def\toctype{num}%
4506 \gdef\thissection{#1}%
4507 \fi\fi\fi
4508 %
4509 % Write the toc entry (before \donoderef). See comments in \chapmacro.
4510 \writetocentry{\toctype\sectionlevel}{#1}{#4}%
4511 %
4512 % Write the node reference (= pdf destination for pdftex).
4513 % Again, see comments in \chapmacro.
4514 \donoderef{#3}%
4515 %
4516 % Interline glue will be inserted when the vbox is completed.
4517 % That glue will be a valid breakpoint for the page, since it'll be
4518 % preceded by a whatsit (usually from the \donoderef, or from the
4519 % \writetocentry if there was no node). We don't want to allow that
4520 % break, since then the whatsits could end up on page n while the
4521 % section is on page n+1, thus toc/etc. are wrong. Debian bug 276000.
4522 \nobreak
4523 %
4524 % Output the actual section heading.
4525 \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000 \tolerance=5000 \parindent=0pt \raggedright
4526 \hangindent=\wd0 % zero if no section number
4527 \unhbox0 #1}%
4528 }%
4529 % Add extra space after the heading -- half of whatever came above it.
4530 % Don't allow stretch, though.
4531 \kern .5 \csname #2headingskip\endcsname
4532 %
4533 % Do not let the kern be a potential breakpoint, as it would be if it
4534 % was followed by glue.
4535 \nobreak
4536 %
4537 % We'll almost certainly start a paragraph next, so don't let that
4538 % glue accumulate. (Not a breakpoint because it's preceded by a
4539 % discardable item.)
4540 \vskip-\parskip
4541 %
4542 % This is purely so the last item on the list is a known \penalty >
4543 % 10000. This is so \startdefun can avoid allowing breakpoints after
4544 % section headings. Otherwise, it would insert a valid breakpoint between:
4545 %
4546 % @section sec-whatever
4547 % @deffn def-whatever
4548 \penalty 10001
4549 }
4550
4551
4552 \message{toc,}
4553 % Table of contents.
4554 \newwrite\tocfile
4555
4556 % Write an entry to the toc file, opening it if necessary.
4557 % Called from @chapter, etc.
4558 %
4559 % Example usage: \writetocentry{sec}{Section Name}{\the\chapno.\the\secno}
4560 % We append the current node name (if any) and page number as additional
4561 % arguments for the \{chap,sec,...}entry macros which will eventually
4562 % read this. The node name is used in the pdf outlines as the
4563 % destination to jump to.
4564 %
4565 % We open the .toc file for writing here instead of at @setfilename (or
4566 % any other fixed time) so that @contents can be anywhere in the document.
4567 % But if #1 is `omit', then we don't do anything. This is used for the
4568 % table of contents chapter openings themselves.
4569 %
4570 \newif\iftocfileopened
4571 \def\omitkeyword{omit}%
4572 %
4573 \def\writetocentry#1#2#3{%
4574 \edef\writetoctype{#1}%
4575 \ifx\writetoctype\omitkeyword \else
4576 \iftocfileopened\else
4577 \immediate\openout\tocfile = \jobname.toc
4578 \global\tocfileopenedtrue
4579 \fi
4580 %
4581 \iflinks
4582 {\atdummies
4583 \edef\temp{%
4584 \write\tocfile{@#1entry{#2}{#3}{\lastnode}{\noexpand\folio}}}%
4585 \temp
4586 }%
4587 \fi
4588 \fi
4589 %
4590 % Tell \shipout to create a pdf destination on each page, if we're
4591 % writing pdf. These are used in the table of contents. We can't
4592 % just write one on every page because the title pages are numbered
4593 % 1 and 2 (the page numbers aren't printed), and so are the first
4594 % two pages of the document. Thus, we'd have two destinations named
4595 % `1', and two named `2'.
4596 \ifpdf \global\pdfmakepagedesttrue \fi
4597 }
4598
4599
4600 % These characters do not print properly in the Computer Modern roman
4601 % fonts, so we must take special care. This is more or less redundant
4602 % with the Texinfo input format setup at the end of this file.
4603 %
4604 \def\activecatcodes{%
4605 \catcode`\"=\active
4606 \catcode`\$=\active
4607 \catcode`\<=\active
4608 \catcode`\>=\active
4609 \catcode`\\=\active
4610 \catcode`\^=\active
4611 \catcode`\_=\active
4612 \catcode`\|=\active
4613 \catcode`\~=\active
4614 }
4615
4616
4617 % Read the toc file, which is essentially Texinfo input.
4618 \def\readtocfile{%
4619 \setupdatafile
4620 \activecatcodes
4621 \input \jobname.toc
4622 }
4623
4624 \newskip\contentsrightmargin \contentsrightmargin=1in
4625 \newcount\savepageno
4626 \newcount\lastnegativepageno \lastnegativepageno = -1
4627
4628 % Prepare to read what we've written to \tocfile.
4629 %
4630 \def\startcontents#1{%
4631 % If @setchapternewpage on, and @headings double, the contents should
4632 % start on an odd page, unlike chapters. Thus, we maintain
4633 % \contentsalignmacro in parallel with \pagealignmacro.
4634 % From: Torbjorn Granlund <tege@matematik.su.se>
4635 \contentsalignmacro
4636 \immediate\closeout\tocfile
4637 %
4638 % Don't need to put `Contents' or `Short Contents' in the headline.
4639 % It is abundantly clear what they are.
4640 \def\thischapter{}%
4641 \chapmacro{#1}{Yomitfromtoc}{}%
4642 %
4643 \savepageno = \pageno
4644 \begingroup % Set up to handle contents files properly.
4645 \raggedbottom % Worry more about breakpoints than the bottom.
4646 \advance\hsize by -\contentsrightmargin % Don't use the full line length.
4647 %
4648 % Roman numerals for page numbers.
4649 \ifnum \pageno>0 \global\pageno = \lastnegativepageno \fi
4650 }
4651
4652
4653 % Normal (long) toc.
4654 \def\contents{%
4655 \startcontents{\putwordTOC}%
4656 \openin 1 \jobname.toc
4657 \ifeof 1 \else
4658 \readtocfile
4659 \fi
4660 \vfill \eject
4661 \contentsalignmacro % in case @setchapternewpage odd is in effect
4662 \ifeof 1 \else
4663 \pdfmakeoutlines
4664 \fi
4665 \closein 1
4666 \endgroup
4667 \lastnegativepageno = \pageno
4668 \global\pageno = \savepageno
4669 }
4670
4671 % And just the chapters.
4672 \def\summarycontents{%
4673 \startcontents{\putwordShortTOC}%
4674 %
4675 \let\numchapentry = \shortchapentry
4676 \let\appentry = \shortchapentry
4677 \let\unnchapentry = \shortunnchapentry
4678 % We want a true roman here for the page numbers.
4679 \secfonts
4680 \let\rm=\shortcontrm \let\bf=\shortcontbf
4681 \let\sl=\shortcontsl \let\tt=\shortconttt
4682 \rm
4683 \hyphenpenalty = 10000
4684 \advance\baselineskip by 1pt % Open it up a little.
4685 \def\numsecentry##1##2##3##4{}
4686 \let\appsecentry = \numsecentry
4687 \let\unnsecentry = \numsecentry
4688 \let\numsubsecentry = \numsecentry
4689 \let\appsubsecentry = \numsecentry
4690 \let\unnsubsecentry = \numsecentry
4691 \let\numsubsubsecentry = \numsecentry
4692 \let\appsubsubsecentry = \numsecentry
4693 \let\unnsubsubsecentry = \numsecentry
4694 \openin 1 \jobname.toc
4695 \ifeof 1 \else
4696 \readtocfile
4697 \fi
4698 \closein 1
4699 \vfill \eject
4700 \contentsalignmacro % in case @setchapternewpage odd is in effect
4701 \endgroup
4702 \lastnegativepageno = \pageno
4703 \global\pageno = \savepageno
4704 }
4705 \let\shortcontents = \summarycontents
4706
4707 % Typeset the label for a chapter or appendix for the short contents.
4708 % The arg is, e.g., `A' for an appendix, or `3' for a chapter.
4709 %
4710 \def\shortchaplabel#1{%
4711 % This space should be enough, since a single number is .5em, and the
4712 % widest letter (M) is 1em, at least in the Computer Modern fonts.
4713 % But use \hss just in case.
4714 % (This space doesn't include the extra space that gets added after
4715 % the label; that gets put in by \shortchapentry above.)
4716 %
4717 % We'd like to right-justify chapter numbers, but that looks strange
4718 % with appendix letters. And right-justifying numbers and
4719 % left-justifying letters looks strange when there is less than 10
4720 % chapters. Have to read the whole toc once to know how many chapters
4721 % there are before deciding ...
4722 \hbox to 1em{#1\hss}%
4723 }
4724
4725 % These macros generate individual entries in the table of contents.
4726 % The first argument is the chapter or section name.
4727 % The last argument is the page number.
4728 % The arguments in between are the chapter number, section number, ...
4729
4730 % Chapters, in the main contents.
4731 \def\numchapentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}}
4732 %
4733 % Chapters, in the short toc.
4734 % See comments in \dochapentry re vbox and related settings.
4735 \def\shortchapentry#1#2#3#4{%
4736 \tocentry{\shortchaplabel{#2}\labelspace #1}{\doshortpageno\bgroup#4\egroup}%
4737 }
4738
4739 % Appendices, in the main contents.
4740 % Need the word Appendix, and a fixed-size box.
4741 %
4742 \def\appendixbox#1{%
4743 % We use M since it's probably the widest letter.
4744 \setbox0 = \hbox{\putwordAppendix{} M}%
4745 \hbox to \wd0{\putwordAppendix{} #1\hss}}
4746 %
4747 \def\appentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{\appendixbox{#2}\labelspace#1}{#4}}
4748
4749 % Unnumbered chapters.
4750 \def\unnchapentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{#1}{#4}}
4751 \def\shortunnchapentry#1#2#3#4{\tocentry{#1}{\doshortpageno\bgroup#4\egroup}}
4752
4753 % Sections.
4754 \def\numsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosecentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}}
4755 \let\appsecentry=\numsecentry
4756 \def\unnsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosecentry{#1}{#4}}
4757
4758 % Subsections.
4759 \def\numsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsecentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}}
4760 \let\appsubsecentry=\numsubsecentry
4761 \def\unnsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsecentry{#1}{#4}}
4762
4763 % And subsubsections.
4764 \def\numsubsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsubsecentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}}
4765 \let\appsubsubsecentry=\numsubsubsecentry
4766 \def\unnsubsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsubsecentry{#1}{#4}}
4767
4768 % This parameter controls the indentation of the various levels.
4769 % Same as \defaultparindent.
4770 \newdimen\tocindent \tocindent = 15pt
4771
4772 % Now for the actual typesetting. In all these, #1 is the text and #2 is the
4773 % page number.
4774 %
4775 % If the toc has to be broken over pages, we want it to be at chapters
4776 % if at all possible; hence the \penalty.
4777 \def\dochapentry#1#2{%
4778 \penalty-300 \vskip1\baselineskip plus.33\baselineskip minus.25\baselineskip
4779 \begingroup
4780 \chapentryfonts
4781 \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}%
4782 \endgroup
4783 \nobreak\vskip .25\baselineskip plus.1\baselineskip
4784 }
4785
4786 \def\dosecentry#1#2{\begingroup
4787 \secentryfonts \leftskip=\tocindent
4788 \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}%
4789 \endgroup}
4790
4791 \def\dosubsecentry#1#2{\begingroup
4792 \subsecentryfonts \leftskip=2\tocindent
4793 \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}%
4794 \endgroup}
4795
4796 \def\dosubsubsecentry#1#2{\begingroup
4797 \subsubsecentryfonts \leftskip=3\tocindent
4798 \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}%
4799 \endgroup}
4800
4801 % We use the same \entry macro as for the index entries.
4802 \let\tocentry = \entry
4803
4804 % Space between chapter (or whatever) number and the title.
4805 \def\labelspace{\hskip1em \relax}
4806
4807 \def\dopageno#1{{\rm #1}}
4808 \def\doshortpageno#1{{\rm #1}}
4809
4810 \def\chapentryfonts{\secfonts \rm}
4811 \def\secentryfonts{\textfonts}
4812 \def\subsecentryfonts{\textfonts}
4813 \def\subsubsecentryfonts{\textfonts}
4814
4815
4816 \message{environments,}
4817 % @foo ... @end foo.
4818
4819 % @point{}, @result{}, @expansion{}, @print{}, @equiv{}.
4820 %
4821 % Since these characters are used in examples, it should be an even number of
4822 % \tt widths. Each \tt character is 1en, so two makes it 1em.
4823 %
4824 \def\point{$\star$}
4825 \def\result{\leavevmode\raise.15ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\Rightarrow$\hfil}}
4826 \def\expansion{\leavevmode\raise.1ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\mapsto$\hfil}}
4827 \def\print{\leavevmode\lower.1ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\dashv$\hfil}}
4828 \def\equiv{\leavevmode\lower.1ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\ptexequiv$\hfil}}
4829
4830 % The @error{} command.
4831 % Adapted from the TeXbook's \boxit.
4832 %
4833 \newbox\errorbox
4834 %
4835 {\tentt \global\dimen0 = 3em}% Width of the box.
4836 \dimen2 = .55pt % Thickness of rules
4837 % The text. (`r' is open on the right, `e' somewhat less so on the left.)
4838 \setbox0 = \hbox{\kern-.75pt \tensf error\kern-1.5pt}
4839 %
4840 \setbox\errorbox=\hbox to \dimen0{\hfil
4841 \hsize = \dimen0 \advance\hsize by -5.8pt % Space to left+right.
4842 \advance\hsize by -2\dimen2 % Rules.
4843 \vbox{%
4844 \hrule height\dimen2
4845 \hbox{\vrule width\dimen2 \kern3pt % Space to left of text.
4846 \vtop{\kern2.4pt \box0 \kern2.4pt}% Space above/below.
4847 \kern3pt\vrule width\dimen2}% Space to right.
4848 \hrule height\dimen2}
4849 \hfil}
4850 %
4851 \def\error{\leavevmode\lower.7ex\copy\errorbox}
4852
4853 % @tex ... @end tex escapes into raw Tex temporarily.
4854 % One exception: @ is still an escape character, so that @end tex works.
4855 % But \@ or @@ will get a plain tex @ character.
4856
4857 \envdef\tex{%
4858 \catcode `\\=0 \catcode `\{=1 \catcode `\}=2
4859 \catcode `\$=3 \catcode `\&=4 \catcode `\#=6
4860 \catcode `\^=7 \catcode `\_=8 \catcode `\~=\active \let~=\tie
4861 \catcode `\%=14
4862 \catcode `\+=\other
4863 \catcode `\"=\other
4864 \catcode `\|=\other
4865 \catcode `\<=\other
4866 \catcode `\>=\other
4867 \escapechar=`\\
4868 %
4869 \let\b=\ptexb
4870 \let\bullet=\ptexbullet
4871 \let\c=\ptexc
4872 \let\,=\ptexcomma
4873 \let\.=\ptexdot
4874 \let\dots=\ptexdots
4875 \let\equiv=\ptexequiv
4876 \let\!=\ptexexclam
4877 \let\i=\ptexi
4878 \let\indent=\ptexindent
4879 \let\noindent=\ptexnoindent
4880 \let\{=\ptexlbrace
4881 \let\+=\tabalign
4882 \let\}=\ptexrbrace
4883 \let\/=\ptexslash
4884 \let\*=\ptexstar
4885 \let\t=\ptext
4886 \let\frenchspacing=\plainfrenchspacing
4887 %
4888 \def\endldots{\mathinner{\ldots\ldots\ldots\ldots}}%
4889 \def\enddots{\relax\ifmmode\endldots\else$\mathsurround=0pt \endldots\,$\fi}%
4890 \def\@{@}%
4891 }
4892 % There is no need to define \Etex.
4893
4894 % Define @lisp ... @end lisp.
4895 % @lisp environment forms a group so it can rebind things,
4896 % including the definition of @end lisp (which normally is erroneous).
4897
4898 % Amount to narrow the margins by for @lisp.
4899 \newskip\lispnarrowing \lispnarrowing=0.4in
4900
4901 % This is the definition that ^^M gets inside @lisp, @example, and other
4902 % such environments. \null is better than a space, since it doesn't
4903 % have any width.
4904 \def\lisppar{\null\endgraf}
4905
4906 % This space is always present above and below environments.
4907 \newskip\envskipamount \envskipamount = 0pt
4908
4909 % Make spacing and below environment symmetrical. We use \parskip here
4910 % to help in doing that, since in @example-like environments \parskip
4911 % is reset to zero; thus the \afterenvbreak inserts no space -- but the
4912 % start of the next paragraph will insert \parskip.
4913 %
4914 \def\aboveenvbreak{{%
4915 % =10000 instead of <10000 because of a special case in \itemzzz and
4916 % \sectionheading, q.v.
4917 \ifnum \lastpenalty=10000 \else
4918 \advance\envskipamount by \parskip
4919 \endgraf
4920 \ifdim\lastskip<\envskipamount
4921 \removelastskip
4922 % it's not a good place to break if the last penalty was \nobreak
4923 % or better ...
4924 \ifnum\lastpenalty<10000 \penalty-50 \fi
4925 \vskip\envskipamount
4926 \fi
4927 \fi
4928 }}
4929
4930 \let\afterenvbreak = \aboveenvbreak
4931
4932 % \nonarrowing is a flag. If "set", @lisp etc don't narrow margins; it will
4933 % also clear it, so that its embedded environments do the narrowing again.
4934 \let\nonarrowing=\relax
4935
4936 % @cartouche ... @end cartouche: draw rectangle w/rounded corners around
4937 % environment contents.
4938 \font\circle=lcircle10
4939 \newdimen\circthick
4940 \newdimen\cartouter\newdimen\cartinner
4941 \newskip\normbskip\newskip\normpskip\newskip\normlskip
4942 \circthick=\fontdimen8\circle
4943 %
4944 \def\ctl{{\circle\char'013\hskip -6pt}}% 6pt from pl file: 1/2charwidth
4945 \def\ctr{{\hskip 6pt\circle\char'010}}
4946 \def\cbl{{\circle\char'012\hskip -6pt}}
4947 \def\cbr{{\hskip 6pt\circle\char'011}}
4948 \def\carttop{\hbox to \cartouter{\hskip\lskip
4949 \ctl\leaders\hrule height\circthick\hfil\ctr
4950 \hskip\rskip}}
4951 \def\cartbot{\hbox to \cartouter{\hskip\lskip
4952 \cbl\leaders\hrule height\circthick\hfil\cbr
4953 \hskip\rskip}}
4954 %
4955 \newskip\lskip\newskip\rskip
4956
4957 \envdef\cartouche{%
4958 \ifhmode\par\fi % can't be in the midst of a paragraph.
4959 \startsavinginserts
4960 \lskip=\leftskip \rskip=\rightskip
4961 \leftskip=0pt\rightskip=0pt % we want these *outside*.
4962 \cartinner=\hsize \advance\cartinner by-\lskip
4963 \advance\cartinner by-\rskip
4964 \cartouter=\hsize
4965 \advance\cartouter by 18.4pt % allow for 3pt kerns on either
4966 % side, and for 6pt waste from
4967 % each corner char, and rule thickness
4968 \normbskip=\baselineskip \normpskip=\parskip \normlskip=\lineskip
4969 % Flag to tell @lisp, etc., not to narrow margin.
4970 \let\nonarrowing = t%
4971 \vbox\bgroup
4972 \baselineskip=0pt\parskip=0pt\lineskip=0pt
4973 \carttop
4974 \hbox\bgroup
4975 \hskip\lskip
4976 \vrule\kern3pt
4977 \vbox\bgroup
4978 \kern3pt
4979 \hsize=\cartinner
4980 \baselineskip=\normbskip
4981 \lineskip=\normlskip
4982 \parskip=\normpskip
4983 \vskip -\parskip
4984 \comment % For explanation, see the end of \def\group.
4985 }
4986 \def\Ecartouche{%
4987 \ifhmode\par\fi
4988 \kern3pt
4989 \egroup
4990 \kern3pt\vrule
4991 \hskip\rskip
4992 \egroup
4993 \cartbot
4994 \egroup
4995 \checkinserts
4996 }
4997
4998
4999 % This macro is called at the beginning of all the @example variants,
5000 % inside a group.
5001 \def\nonfillstart{%
5002 \aboveenvbreak
5003 \hfuzz = 12pt % Don't be fussy
5004 \sepspaces % Make spaces be word-separators rather than space tokens.
5005 \let\par = \lisppar % don't ignore blank lines
5006 \obeylines % each line of input is a line of output
5007 \parskip = 0pt
5008 \parindent = 0pt
5009 \emergencystretch = 0pt % don't try to avoid overfull boxes
5010 \ifx\nonarrowing\relax
5011 \advance \leftskip by \lispnarrowing
5012 \exdentamount=\lispnarrowing
5013 \else
5014 \let\nonarrowing = \relax
5015 \fi
5016 \let\exdent=\nofillexdent
5017 }
5018
5019 % If you want all examples etc. small: @set dispenvsize small.
5020 % If you want even small examples the full size: @set dispenvsize nosmall.
5021 % This affects the following displayed environments:
5022 % @example, @display, @format, @lisp
5023 %
5024 \def\smallword{small}
5025 \def\nosmallword{nosmall}
5026 \let\SETdispenvsize\relax
5027 \def\setnormaldispenv{%
5028 \ifx\SETdispenvsize\smallword
5029 \smallexamplefonts \rm
5030 \fi
5031 }
5032 \def\setsmalldispenv{%
5033 \ifx\SETdispenvsize\nosmallword
5034 \else
5035 \smallexamplefonts \rm
5036 \fi
5037 }
5038
5039 % We often define two environments, @foo and @smallfoo.
5040 % Let's do it by one command:
5041 \def\makedispenv #1#2{
5042 \expandafter\envdef\csname#1\endcsname {\setnormaldispenv #2}
5043 \expandafter\envdef\csname small#1\endcsname {\setsmalldispenv #2}
5044 \expandafter\let\csname E#1\endcsname \afterenvbreak
5045 \expandafter\let\csname Esmall#1\endcsname \afterenvbreak
5046 }
5047
5048 % Define two synonyms:
5049 \def\maketwodispenvs #1#2#3{
5050 \makedispenv{#1}{#3}
5051 \makedispenv{#2}{#3}
5052 }
5053
5054 % @lisp: indented, narrowed, typewriter font; @example: same as @lisp.
5055 %
5056 % @smallexample and @smalllisp: use smaller fonts.
5057 % Originally contributed by Pavel@xerox.
5058 %
5059 \maketwodispenvs {lisp}{example}{%
5060 \nonfillstart
5061 \tt
5062 \let\kbdfont = \kbdexamplefont % Allow @kbd to do something special.
5063 \gobble % eat return
5064 }
5065
5066 % @display/@smalldisplay: same as @lisp except keep current font.
5067 %
5068 \makedispenv {display}{%
5069 \nonfillstart
5070 \gobble
5071 }
5072
5073 % @format/@smallformat: same as @display except don't narrow margins.
5074 %
5075 \makedispenv{format}{%
5076 \let\nonarrowing = t%
5077 \nonfillstart
5078 \gobble
5079 }
5080
5081 % @flushleft: same as @format, but doesn't obey \SETdispenvsize.
5082 \envdef\flushleft{%
5083 \let\nonarrowing = t%
5084 \nonfillstart
5085 \gobble
5086 }
5087 \let\Eflushleft = \afterenvbreak
5088
5089 % @flushright.
5090 %
5091 \envdef\flushright{%
5092 \let\nonarrowing = t%
5093 \nonfillstart
5094 \advance\leftskip by 0pt plus 1fill
5095 \gobble
5096 }
5097 \let\Eflushright = \afterenvbreak
5098
5099
5100 % @quotation does normal linebreaking (hence we can't use \nonfillstart)
5101 % and narrows the margins. We keep \parskip nonzero in general, since
5102 % we're doing normal filling. So, when using \aboveenvbreak and
5103 % \afterenvbreak, temporarily make \parskip 0.
5104 %
5105 \envdef\quotation{%
5106 {\parskip=0pt \aboveenvbreak}% because \aboveenvbreak inserts \parskip
5107 \parindent=0pt
5108 %
5109 % @cartouche defines \nonarrowing to inhibit narrowing at next level down.
5110 \ifx\nonarrowing\relax
5111 \advance\leftskip by \lispnarrowing
5112 \advance\rightskip by \lispnarrowing
5113 \exdentamount = \lispnarrowing
5114 \else
5115 \let\nonarrowing = \relax
5116 \fi
5117 \parsearg\quotationlabel
5118 }
5119
5120 % We have retained a nonzero parskip for the environment, since we're
5121 % doing normal filling.
5122 %
5123 \def\Equotation{%
5124 \par
5125 \ifx\quotationauthor\undefined\else
5126 % indent a bit.
5127 \leftline{\kern 2\leftskip \sl ---\quotationauthor}%
5128 \fi
5129 {\parskip=0pt \afterenvbreak}%
5130 }
5131
5132 % If we're given an argument, typeset it in bold with a colon after.
5133 \def\quotationlabel#1{%
5134 \def\temp{#1}%
5135 \ifx\temp\empty \else
5136 {\bf #1: }%
5137 \fi
5138 }
5139
5140
5141 % LaTeX-like @verbatim...@end verbatim and @verb{<char>...<char>}
5142 % If we want to allow any <char> as delimiter,
5143 % we need the curly braces so that makeinfo sees the @verb command, eg:
5144 % `@verbx...x' would look like the '@verbx' command. --janneke@gnu.org
5145 %
5146 % [Knuth]: Donald Ervin Knuth, 1996. The TeXbook.
5147 %
5148 % [Knuth] p.344; only we need to do the other characters Texinfo sets
5149 % active too. Otherwise, they get lost as the first character on a
5150 % verbatim line.
5151 \def\dospecials{%
5152 \do\ \do\\\do\{\do\}\do\$\do\&%
5153 \do\#\do\^\do\^^K\do\_\do\^^A\do\%\do\~%
5154 \do\<\do\>\do\|\do\@\do+\do\"%
5155 }
5156 %
5157 % [Knuth] p. 380
5158 \def\uncatcodespecials{%
5159 \def\do##1{\catcode`##1=\other}\dospecials}
5160 %
5161 % [Knuth] pp. 380,381,391
5162 % Disable Spanish ligatures ?` and !` of \tt font
5163 \begingroup
5164 \catcode`\`=\active\gdef`{\relax\lq}
5165 \endgroup
5166 %
5167 % Setup for the @verb command.
5168 %
5169 % Eight spaces for a tab
5170 \begingroup
5171 \catcode`\^^I=\active
5172 \gdef\tabeightspaces{\catcode`\^^I=\active\def^^I{\ \ \ \ \ \ \ \ }}
5173 \endgroup
5174 %
5175 \def\setupverb{%
5176 \tt % easiest (and conventionally used) font for verbatim
5177 \def\par{\leavevmode\endgraf}%
5178 \catcode`\`=\active
5179 \tabeightspaces
5180 % Respect line breaks,
5181 % print special symbols as themselves, and
5182 % make each space count
5183 % must do in this order:
5184 \obeylines \uncatcodespecials \sepspaces
5185 }
5186
5187 % Setup for the @verbatim environment
5188 %
5189 % Real tab expansion
5190 \newdimen\tabw \setbox0=\hbox{\tt\space} \tabw=8\wd0 % tab amount
5191 %
5192 \def\starttabbox{\setbox0=\hbox\bgroup}
5193 \begingroup
5194 \catcode`\^^I=\active
5195 \gdef\tabexpand{%
5196 \catcode`\^^I=\active
5197 \def^^I{\leavevmode\egroup
5198 \dimen0=\wd0 % the width so far, or since the previous tab
5199 \divide\dimen0 by\tabw
5200 \multiply\dimen0 by\tabw % compute previous multiple of \tabw
5201 \advance\dimen0 by\tabw % advance to next multiple of \tabw
5202 \wd0=\dimen0 \box0 \starttabbox
5203 }%
5204 }
5205 \endgroup
5206 \def\setupverbatim{%
5207 \let\nonarrowing = t%
5208 \nonfillstart
5209 % Easiest (and conventionally used) font for verbatim
5210 \tt
5211 \def\par{\leavevmode\egroup\box0\endgraf}%
5212 \catcode`\`=\active
5213 \tabexpand
5214 % Respect line breaks,
5215 % print special symbols as themselves, and
5216 % make each space count
5217 % must do in this order:
5218 \obeylines \uncatcodespecials \sepspaces
5219 \everypar{\starttabbox}%
5220 }
5221
5222 % Do the @verb magic: verbatim text is quoted by unique
5223 % delimiter characters. Before first delimiter expect a
5224 % right brace, after last delimiter expect closing brace:
5225 %
5226 % \def\doverb'{'<char>#1<char>'}'{#1}
5227 %
5228 % [Knuth] p. 382; only eat outer {}
5229 \begingroup
5230 \catcode`[=1\catcode`]=2\catcode`\{=\other\catcode`\}=\other
5231 \gdef\doverb{#1[\def\next##1#1}[##1\endgroup]\next]
5232 \endgroup
5233 %
5234 \def\verb{\begingroup\setupverb\doverb}
5235 %
5236 %
5237 % Do the @verbatim magic: define the macro \doverbatim so that
5238 % the (first) argument ends when '@end verbatim' is reached, ie:
5239 %
5240 % \def\doverbatim#1@end verbatim{#1}
5241 %
5242 % For Texinfo it's a lot easier than for LaTeX,
5243 % because texinfo's \verbatim doesn't stop at '\end{verbatim}':
5244 % we need not redefine '\', '{' and '}'.
5245 %
5246 % Inspired by LaTeX's verbatim command set [latex.ltx]
5247 %
5248 \begingroup
5249 \catcode`\ =\active
5250 \obeylines %
5251 % ignore everything up to the first ^^M, that's the newline at the end
5252 % of the @verbatim input line itself. Otherwise we get an extra blank
5253 % line in the output.
5254 \xdef\doverbatim#1^^M#2@end verbatim{#2\noexpand\end\gobble verbatim}%
5255 % We really want {...\end verbatim} in the body of the macro, but
5256 % without the active space; thus we have to use \xdef and \gobble.
5257 \endgroup
5258 %
5259 \envdef\verbatim{%
5260 \setupverbatim\doverbatim
5261 }
5262 \let\Everbatim = \afterenvbreak
5263
5264
5265 % @verbatiminclude FILE - insert text of file in verbatim environment.
5266 %
5267 \def\verbatiminclude{\parseargusing\filenamecatcodes\doverbatiminclude}
5268 %
5269 \def\doverbatiminclude#1{%
5270 {%
5271 \makevalueexpandable
5272 \setupverbatim
5273 \input #1
5274 \afterenvbreak
5275 }%
5276 }
5277
5278 % @copying ... @end copying.
5279 % Save the text away for @insertcopying later.
5280 %
5281 % We save the uninterpreted tokens, rather than creating a box.
5282 % Saving the text in a box would be much easier, but then all the
5283 % typesetting commands (@smallbook, font changes, etc.) have to be done
5284 % beforehand -- and a) we want @copying to be done first in the source
5285 % file; b) letting users define the frontmatter in as flexible order as
5286 % possible is very desirable.
5287 %
5288 \def\copying{\checkenv{}\begingroup\scanargctxt\docopying}
5289 \def\docopying#1@end copying{\endgroup\def\copyingtext{#1}}
5290 %
5291 \def\insertcopying{%
5292 \begingroup
5293 \parindent = 0pt % paragraph indentation looks wrong on title page
5294 \scanexp\copyingtext
5295 \endgroup
5296 }
5297
5298 \message{defuns,}
5299 % @defun etc.
5300
5301 \newskip\defbodyindent \defbodyindent=.4in
5302 \newskip\defargsindent \defargsindent=50pt
5303 \newskip\deflastargmargin \deflastargmargin=18pt
5304
5305 % Start the processing of @deffn:
5306 \def\startdefun{%
5307 \ifnum\lastpenalty<10000
5308 \medbreak
5309 \else
5310 % If there are two @def commands in a row, we'll have a \nobreak,
5311 % which is there to keep the function description together with its
5312 % header. But if there's nothing but headers, we need to allow a
5313 % break somewhere. Check specifically for penalty 10002, inserted
5314 % by \defargscommonending, instead of 10000, since the sectioning
5315 % commands also insert a nobreak penalty, and we don't want to allow
5316 % a break between a section heading and a defun.
5317 %
5318 \ifnum\lastpenalty=10002 \penalty2000 \fi
5319 %
5320 % Similarly, after a section heading, do not allow a break.
5321 % But do insert the glue.
5322 \medskip % preceded by discardable penalty, so not a breakpoint
5323 \fi
5324 %
5325 \parindent=0in
5326 \advance\leftskip by \defbodyindent
5327 \exdentamount=\defbodyindent
5328 }
5329
5330 \def\dodefunx#1{%
5331 % First, check whether we are in the right environment:
5332 \checkenv#1%
5333 %
5334 % As above, allow line break if we have multiple x headers in a row.
5335 % It's not a great place, though.
5336 \ifnum\lastpenalty=10002 \penalty3000 \fi
5337 %
5338 % And now, it's time to reuse the body of the original defun:
5339 \expandafter\gobbledefun#1%
5340 }
5341 \def\gobbledefun#1\startdefun{}
5342
5343 % \printdefunline \deffnheader{text}
5344 %
5345 \def\printdefunline#1#2{%
5346 \begingroup
5347 % call \deffnheader:
5348 #1#2 \endheader
5349 % common ending:
5350 \interlinepenalty = 10000
5351 \advance\rightskip by 0pt plus 1fil
5352 \endgraf
5353 \nobreak\vskip -\parskip
5354 \penalty 10002 % signal to \startdefun and \dodefunx
5355 % Some of the @defun-type tags do not enable magic parentheses,
5356 % rendering the following check redundant. But we don't optimize.
5357 \checkparencounts
5358 \endgroup
5359 }
5360
5361 \def\Edefun{\endgraf\medbreak}
5362
5363 % \makedefun{deffn} creates \deffn, \deffnx and \Edeffn;
5364 % the only thing remainnig is to define \deffnheader.
5365 %
5366 \def\makedefun#1{%
5367 \expandafter\let\csname E#1\endcsname = \Edefun
5368 \edef\temp{\noexpand\domakedefun
5369 \makecsname{#1}\makecsname{#1x}\makecsname{#1header}}%
5370 \temp
5371 }
5372
5373 % \domakedefun \deffn \deffnx \deffnheader
5374 %
5375 % Define \deffn and \deffnx, without parameters.
5376 % \deffnheader has to be defined explicitly.
5377 %
5378 \def\domakedefun#1#2#3{%
5379 \envdef#1{%
5380 \startdefun
5381 \parseargusing\activeparens{\printdefunline#3}%
5382 }%
5383 \def#2{\dodefunx#1}%
5384 \def#3%
5385 }
5386
5387 %%% Untyped functions:
5388
5389 % @deffn category name args
5390 \makedefun{deffn}{\deffngeneral{}}
5391
5392 % @deffn category class name args
5393 \makedefun{defop}#1 {\defopon{#1\ \putwordon}}
5394
5395 % \defopon {category on}class name args
5396 \def\defopon#1#2 {\deffngeneral{\putwordon\ \code{#2}}{#1\ \code{#2}} }
5397
5398 % \deffngeneral {subind}category name args
5399 %
5400 \def\deffngeneral#1#2 #3 #4\endheader{%
5401 % Remember that \dosubind{fn}{foo}{} is equivalent to \doind{fn}{foo}.
5402 \dosubind{fn}{\code{#3}}{#1}%
5403 \defname{#2}{}{#3}\magicamp\defunargs{#4\unskip}%
5404 }
5405
5406 %%% Typed functions:
5407
5408 % @deftypefn category type name args
5409 \makedefun{deftypefn}{\deftypefngeneral{}}
5410
5411 % @deftypeop category class type name args
5412 \makedefun{deftypeop}#1 {\deftypeopon{#1\ \putwordon}}
5413
5414 % \deftypeopon {category on}class type name args
5415 \def\deftypeopon#1#2 {\deftypefngeneral{\putwordon\ \code{#2}}{#1\ \code{#2}} }
5416
5417 % \deftypefngeneral {subind}category type name args
5418 %
5419 \def\deftypefngeneral#1#2 #3 #4 #5\endheader{%
5420 \dosubind{fn}{\code{#4}}{#1}%
5421 \defname{#2}{#3}{#4}\defunargs{#5\unskip}%
5422 }
5423
5424 %%% Typed variables:
5425
5426 % @deftypevr category type var args
5427 \makedefun{deftypevr}{\deftypecvgeneral{}}
5428
5429 % @deftypecv category class type var args
5430 \makedefun{deftypecv}#1 {\deftypecvof{#1\ \putwordof}}
5431
5432 % \deftypecvof {category of}class type var args
5433 \def\deftypecvof#1#2 {\deftypecvgeneral{\putwordof\ \code{#2}}{#1\ \code{#2}} }
5434
5435 % \deftypecvgeneral {subind}category type var args
5436 %
5437 \def\deftypecvgeneral#1#2 #3 #4 #5\endheader{%
5438 \dosubind{vr}{\code{#4}}{#1}%
5439 \defname{#2}{#3}{#4}\defunargs{#5\unskip}%
5440 }
5441
5442 %%% Untyped variables:
5443
5444 % @defvr category var args
5445 \makedefun{defvr}#1 {\deftypevrheader{#1} {} }
5446
5447 % @defcv category class var args
5448 \makedefun{defcv}#1 {\defcvof{#1\ \putwordof}}
5449
5450 % \defcvof {category of}class var args
5451 \def\defcvof#1#2 {\deftypecvof{#1}#2 {} }
5452
5453 %%% Type:
5454 % @deftp category name args
5455 \makedefun{deftp}#1 #2 #3\endheader{%
5456 \doind{tp}{\code{#2}}%
5457 \defname{#1}{}{#2}\defunargs{#3\unskip}%
5458 }
5459
5460 % Remaining @defun-like shortcuts:
5461 \makedefun{defun}{\deffnheader{\putwordDeffunc} }
5462 \makedefun{defmac}{\deffnheader{\putwordDefmac} }
5463 \makedefun{defspec}{\deffnheader{\putwordDefspec} }
5464 \makedefun{deftypefun}{\deftypefnheader{\putwordDeffunc} }
5465 \makedefun{defvar}{\defvrheader{\putwordDefvar} }
5466 \makedefun{defopt}{\defvrheader{\putwordDefopt} }
5467 \makedefun{deftypevar}{\deftypevrheader{\putwordDefvar} }
5468 \makedefun{defmethod}{\defopon\putwordMethodon}
5469 \makedefun{deftypemethod}{\deftypeopon\putwordMethodon}
5470 \makedefun{defivar}{\defcvof\putwordInstanceVariableof}
5471 \makedefun{deftypeivar}{\deftypecvof\putwordInstanceVariableof}
5472
5473 % \defname, which formats the name of the @def (not the args).
5474 % #1 is the category, such as "Function".
5475 % #2 is the return type, if any.
5476 % #3 is the function name.
5477 %
5478 % We are followed by (but not passed) the arguments, if any.
5479 %
5480 \def\defname#1#2#3{%
5481 % Get the values of \leftskip and \rightskip as they were outside the @def...
5482 \advance\leftskip by -\defbodyindent
5483 %
5484 % How we'll format the type name. Putting it in brackets helps
5485 % distinguish it from the body text that may end up on the next line
5486 % just below it.
5487 \def\temp{#1}%
5488 \setbox0=\hbox{\kern\deflastargmargin \ifx\temp\empty\else [\rm\temp]\fi}
5489 %
5490 % Figure out line sizes for the paragraph shape.
5491 % The first line needs space for \box0; but if \rightskip is nonzero,
5492 % we need only space for the part of \box0 which exceeds it:
5493 \dimen0=\hsize \advance\dimen0 by -\wd0 \advance\dimen0 by \rightskip
5494 % The continuations:
5495 \dimen2=\hsize \advance\dimen2 by -\defargsindent
5496 % (plain.tex says that \dimen1 should be used only as global.)
5497 \parshape 2 0in \dimen0 \defargsindent \dimen2
5498 %
5499 % Put the type name to the right margin.
5500 \noindent
5501 \hbox to 0pt{%
5502 \hfil\box0 \kern-\hsize
5503 % \hsize has to be shortened this way:
5504 \kern\leftskip
5505 % Intentionally do not respect \rightskip, since we need the space.
5506 }%
5507 %
5508 % Allow all lines to be underfull without complaint:
5509 \tolerance=10000 \hbadness=10000
5510 \exdentamount=\defbodyindent
5511 {%
5512 % defun fonts. We use typewriter by default (used to be bold) because:
5513 % . we're printing identifiers, they should be in tt in principle.
5514 % . in languages with many accents, such as Czech or French, it's
5515 % common to leave accents off identifiers. The result looks ok in
5516 % tt, but exceedingly strange in rm.
5517 % . we don't want -- and --- to be treated as ligatures.
5518 % . this still does not fix the ?` and !` ligatures, but so far no
5519 % one has made identifiers using them :).
5520 \df \tt
5521 \def\temp{#2}% return value type
5522 \ifx\temp\empty\else \tclose{\temp} \fi
5523 #3% output function name
5524 }%
5525 {\rm\enskip}% hskip 0.5 em of \tenrm
5526 %
5527 \boldbrax
5528 % arguments will be output next, if any.
5529 }
5530
5531 % Print arguments in slanted roman (not ttsl), inconsistently with using
5532 % tt for the name. This is because literal text is sometimes needed in
5533 % the argument list (groff manual), and ttsl and tt are not very
5534 % distinguishable. Prevent hyphenation at `-' chars.
5535 %
5536 \def\defunargs#1{%
5537 % use sl by default (not ttsl),
5538 % tt for the names.
5539 \df \sl \hyphenchar\font=0
5540 %
5541 % On the other hand, if an argument has two dashes (for instance), we
5542 % want a way to get ttsl. Let's try @var for that.
5543 \let\var=\ttslanted
5544 #1%
5545 \sl\hyphenchar\font=45
5546 }
5547
5548 % We want ()&[] to print specially on the defun line.
5549 %
5550 \def\activeparens{%
5551 \catcode`\(=\active \catcode`\)=\active
5552 \catcode`\[=\active \catcode`\]=\active
5553 \catcode`\&=\active
5554 }
5555
5556 % Make control sequences which act like normal parenthesis chars.
5557 \let\lparen = ( \let\rparen = )
5558
5559 % Be sure that we always have a definition for `(', etc. For example,
5560 % if the fn name has parens in it, \boldbrax will not be in effect yet,
5561 % so TeX would otherwise complain about undefined control sequence.
5562 {
5563 \activeparens
5564 \global\let(=\lparen \global\let)=\rparen
5565 \global\let[=\lbrack \global\let]=\rbrack
5566 \global\let& = \&
5567
5568 \gdef\boldbrax{\let(=\opnr\let)=\clnr\let[=\lbrb\let]=\rbrb}
5569 \gdef\magicamp{\let&=\amprm}
5570 }
5571
5572 \newcount\parencount
5573
5574 % If we encounter &foo, then turn on ()-hacking afterwards
5575 \newif\ifampseen
5576 \def\amprm#1 {\ampseentrue{\bf\&#1 }}
5577
5578 \def\parenfont{%
5579 \ifampseen
5580 % At the first level, print parens in roman,
5581 % otherwise use the default font.
5582 \ifnum \parencount=1 \rm \fi
5583 \else
5584 % The \sf parens (in \boldbrax) actually are a little bolder than
5585 % the contained text. This is especially needed for [ and ] .
5586 \sf
5587 \fi
5588 }
5589 \def\infirstlevel#1{%
5590 \ifampseen
5591 \ifnum\parencount=1
5592 #1%
5593 \fi
5594 \fi
5595 }
5596 \def\bfafterword#1 {#1 \bf}
5597
5598 \def\opnr{%
5599 \global\advance\parencount by 1
5600 {\parenfont(}%
5601 \infirstlevel \bfafterword
5602 }
5603 \def\clnr{%
5604 {\parenfont)}%
5605 \infirstlevel \sl
5606 \global\advance\parencount by -1
5607 }
5608
5609 \newcount\brackcount
5610 \def\lbrb{%
5611 \global\advance\brackcount by 1
5612 {\bf[}%
5613 }
5614 \def\rbrb{%
5615 {\bf]}%
5616 \global\advance\brackcount by -1
5617 }
5618
5619 \def\checkparencounts{%
5620 \ifnum\parencount=0 \else \badparencount \fi
5621 \ifnum\brackcount=0 \else \badbrackcount \fi
5622 }
5623 \def\badparencount{%
5624 \errmessage{Unbalanced parentheses in @def}%
5625 \global\parencount=0
5626 }
5627 \def\badbrackcount{%
5628 \errmessage{Unbalanced square braces in @def}%
5629 \global\brackcount=0
5630 }
5631
5632
5633 \message{macros,}
5634 % @macro.
5635
5636 % To do this right we need a feature of e-TeX, \scantokens,
5637 % which we arrange to emulate with a temporary file in ordinary TeX.
5638 \ifx\eTeXversion\undefined
5639 \newwrite\macscribble
5640 \def\scantokens#1{%
5641 \toks0={#1}%
5642 \immediate\openout\macscribble=\jobname.tmp
5643 \immediate\write\macscribble{\the\toks0}%
5644 \immediate\closeout\macscribble
5645 \input \jobname.tmp
5646 }
5647 \fi
5648
5649 \def\scanmacro#1{%
5650 \begingroup
5651 \newlinechar`\^^M
5652 \let\xeatspaces\eatspaces
5653 % Undo catcode changes of \startcontents and \doprintindex
5654 % When called from @insertcopying or (short)caption, we need active
5655 % backslash to get it printed correctly. Previously, we had
5656 % \catcode`\\=\other instead. We'll see whether a problem appears
5657 % with macro expansion. --kasal, 19aug04
5658 \catcode`\@=0 \catcode`\\=\active \escapechar=`\@
5659 % ... and \example
5660 \spaceisspace
5661 %
5662 % Append \endinput to make sure that TeX does not see the ending newline.
5663 %
5664 % I've verified that it is necessary both for e-TeX and for ordinary TeX
5665 % --kasal, 29nov03
5666 \scantokens{#1\endinput}%
5667 \endgroup
5668 }
5669
5670 \def\scanexp#1{%
5671 \edef\temp{\noexpand\scanmacro{#1}}%
5672 \temp
5673 }
5674
5675 \newcount\paramno % Count of parameters
5676 \newtoks\macname % Macro name
5677 \newif\ifrecursive % Is it recursive?
5678
5679 % List of all defined macros in the form
5680 % \definedummyword\macro1\definedummyword\macro2...
5681 % Currently is also contains all @aliases; the list can be split
5682 % if there is a need.
5683 \def\macrolist{}
5684
5685 % Add the macro to \macrolist
5686 \def\addtomacrolist#1{\expandafter \addtomacrolistxxx \csname#1\endcsname}
5687 \def\addtomacrolistxxx#1{%
5688 \toks0 = \expandafter{\macrolist\definedummyword#1}%
5689 \xdef\macrolist{\the\toks0}%
5690 }
5691
5692 % Utility routines.
5693 % This does \let #1 = #2, with \csnames; that is,
5694 % \let \csname#1\endcsname = \csname#2\endcsname
5695 % (except of course we have to play expansion games).
5696 %
5697 \def\cslet#1#2{%
5698 \expandafter\let
5699 \csname#1\expandafter\endcsname
5700 \csname#2\endcsname
5701 }
5702
5703 % Trim leading and trailing spaces off a string.
5704 % Concepts from aro-bend problem 15 (see CTAN).
5705 {\catcode`\@=11
5706 \gdef\eatspaces #1{\expandafter\trim@\expandafter{#1 }}
5707 \gdef\trim@ #1{\trim@@ @#1 @ #1 @ @@}
5708 \gdef\trim@@ #1@ #2@ #3@@{\trim@@@\empty #2 @}
5709 \def\unbrace#1{#1}
5710 \unbrace{\gdef\trim@@@ #1 } #2@{#1}
5711 }
5712
5713 % Trim a single trailing ^^M off a string.
5714 {\catcode`\^^M=\other \catcode`\Q=3%
5715 \gdef\eatcr #1{\eatcra #1Q^^MQ}%
5716 \gdef\eatcra#1^^MQ{\eatcrb#1Q}%
5717 \gdef\eatcrb#1Q#2Q{#1}%
5718 }
5719
5720 % Macro bodies are absorbed as an argument in a context where
5721 % all characters are catcode 10, 11 or 12, except \ which is active
5722 % (as in normal texinfo). It is necessary to change the definition of \.
5723
5724 % It's necessary to have hard CRs when the macro is executed. This is
5725 % done by making ^^M (\endlinechar) catcode 12 when reading the macro
5726 % body, and then making it the \newlinechar in \scanmacro.
5727
5728 \def\scanctxt{%
5729 \catcode`\"=\other
5730 \catcode`\+=\other
5731 \catcode`\<=\other
5732 \catcode`\>=\other
5733 \catcode`\@=\other
5734 \catcode`\^=\other
5735 \catcode`\_=\other
5736 \catcode`\|=\other
5737 \catcode`\~=\other
5738 }
5739
5740 \def\scanargctxt{%
5741 \scanctxt
5742 \catcode`\\=\other
5743 \catcode`\^^M=\other
5744 }
5745
5746 \def\macrobodyctxt{%
5747 \scanctxt
5748 \catcode`\{=\other
5749 \catcode`\}=\other
5750 \catcode`\^^M=\other
5751 \usembodybackslash
5752 }
5753
5754 \def\macroargctxt{%
5755 \scanctxt
5756 \catcode`\\=\other
5757 }
5758
5759 % \mbodybackslash is the definition of \ in @macro bodies.
5760 % It maps \foo\ => \csname macarg.foo\endcsname => #N
5761 % where N is the macro parameter number.
5762 % We define \csname macarg.\endcsname to be \realbackslash, so
5763 % \\ in macro replacement text gets you a backslash.
5764
5765 {\catcode`@=0 @catcode`@\=@active
5766 @gdef@usembodybackslash{@let\=@mbodybackslash}
5767 @gdef@mbodybackslash#1\{@csname macarg.#1@endcsname}
5768 }
5769 \expandafter\def\csname macarg.\endcsname{\realbackslash}
5770
5771 \def\macro{\recursivefalse\parsearg\macroxxx}
5772 \def\rmacro{\recursivetrue\parsearg\macroxxx}
5773
5774 \def\macroxxx#1{%
5775 \getargs{#1}% now \macname is the macname and \argl the arglist
5776 \ifx\argl\empty % no arguments
5777 \paramno=0%
5778 \else
5779 \expandafter\parsemargdef \argl;%
5780 \fi
5781 \if1\csname ismacro.\the\macname\endcsname
5782 \message{Warning: redefining \the\macname}%
5783 \else
5784 \expandafter\ifx\csname \the\macname\endcsname \relax
5785 \else \errmessage{Macro name \the\macname\space already defined}\fi
5786 \global\cslet{macsave.\the\macname}{\the\macname}%
5787 \global\expandafter\let\csname ismacro.\the\macname\endcsname=1%
5788 \addtomacrolist{\the\macname}%
5789 \fi
5790 \begingroup \macrobodyctxt
5791 \ifrecursive \expandafter\parsermacbody
5792 \else \expandafter\parsemacbody
5793 \fi}
5794
5795 \parseargdef\unmacro{%
5796 \if1\csname ismacro.#1\endcsname
5797 \global\cslet{#1}{macsave.#1}%
5798 \global\expandafter\let \csname ismacro.#1\endcsname=0%
5799 % Remove the macro name from \macrolist:
5800 \begingroup
5801 \expandafter\let\csname#1\endcsname \relax
5802 \let\definedummyword\unmacrodo
5803 \xdef\macrolist{\macrolist}%
5804 \endgroup
5805 \else
5806 \errmessage{Macro #1 not defined}%
5807 \fi
5808 }
5809
5810 % Called by \do from \dounmacro on each macro. The idea is to omit any
5811 % macro definitions that have been changed to \relax.
5812 %
5813 \def\unmacrodo#1{%
5814 \ifx #1\relax
5815 % remove this
5816 \else
5817 \noexpand\definedummyword \noexpand#1%
5818 \fi
5819 }
5820
5821 % This makes use of the obscure feature that if the last token of a
5822 % <parameter list> is #, then the preceding argument is delimited by
5823 % an opening brace, and that opening brace is not consumed.
5824 \def\getargs#1{\getargsxxx#1{}}
5825 \def\getargsxxx#1#{\getmacname #1 \relax\getmacargs}
5826 \def\getmacname #1 #2\relax{\macname={#1}}
5827 \def\getmacargs#1{\def\argl{#1}}
5828
5829 % Parse the optional {params} list. Set up \paramno and \paramlist
5830 % so \defmacro knows what to do. Define \macarg.blah for each blah
5831 % in the params list, to be ##N where N is the position in that list.
5832 % That gets used by \mbodybackslash (above).
5833
5834 % We need to get `macro parameter char #' into several definitions.
5835 % The technique used is stolen from LaTeX: let \hash be something
5836 % unexpandable, insert that wherever you need a #, and then redefine
5837 % it to # just before using the token list produced.
5838 %
5839 % The same technique is used to protect \eatspaces till just before
5840 % the macro is used.
5841
5842 \def\parsemargdef#1;{\paramno=0\def\paramlist{}%
5843 \let\hash\relax\let\xeatspaces\relax\parsemargdefxxx#1,;,}
5844 \def\parsemargdefxxx#1,{%
5845 \if#1;\let\next=\relax
5846 \else \let\next=\parsemargdefxxx
5847 \advance\paramno by 1%
5848 \expandafter\edef\csname macarg.\eatspaces{#1}\endcsname
5849 {\xeatspaces{\hash\the\paramno}}%
5850 \edef\paramlist{\paramlist\hash\the\paramno,}%
5851 \fi\next}
5852
5853 % These two commands read recursive and nonrecursive macro bodies.
5854 % (They're different since rec and nonrec macros end differently.)
5855
5856 \long\def\parsemacbody#1@end macro%
5857 {\xdef\temp{\eatcr{#1}}\endgroup\defmacro}%
5858 \long\def\parsermacbody#1@end rmacro%
5859 {\xdef\temp{\eatcr{#1}}\endgroup\defmacro}%
5860
5861 % This defines the macro itself. There are six cases: recursive and
5862 % nonrecursive macros of zero, one, and many arguments.
5863 % Much magic with \expandafter here.
5864 % \xdef is used so that macro definitions will survive the file
5865 % they're defined in; @include reads the file inside a group.
5866 \def\defmacro{%
5867 \let\hash=##% convert placeholders to macro parameter chars
5868 \ifrecursive
5869 \ifcase\paramno
5870 % 0
5871 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
5872 \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}}%
5873 \or % 1
5874 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
5875 \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt
5876 \noexpand\braceorline
5877 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname}%
5878 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname##1{%
5879 \egroup\noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}}%
5880 \else % many
5881 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
5882 \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt
5883 \noexpand\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname}%
5884 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname##1{%
5885 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname ##1,}%
5886 \expandafter\expandafter
5887 \expandafter\xdef
5888 \expandafter\expandafter
5889 \csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname
5890 \paramlist{\egroup\noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}}%
5891 \fi
5892 \else
5893 \ifcase\paramno
5894 % 0
5895 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
5896 \noexpand\norecurse{\the\macname}%
5897 \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}\egroup}%
5898 \or % 1
5899 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
5900 \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt
5901 \noexpand\braceorline
5902 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname}%
5903 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname##1{%
5904 \egroup
5905 \noexpand\norecurse{\the\macname}%
5906 \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}\egroup}%
5907 \else % many
5908 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
5909 \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt
5910 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname}%
5911 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname##1{%
5912 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname ##1,}%
5913 \expandafter\expandafter
5914 \expandafter\xdef
5915 \expandafter\expandafter
5916 \csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname
5917 \paramlist{%
5918 \egroup
5919 \noexpand\norecurse{\the\macname}%
5920 \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}\egroup}%
5921 \fi
5922 \fi}
5923
5924 \def\norecurse#1{\bgroup\cslet{#1}{macsave.#1}}
5925
5926 % \braceorline decides whether the next nonwhitespace character is a
5927 % {. If so it reads up to the closing }, if not, it reads the whole
5928 % line. Whatever was read is then fed to the next control sequence
5929 % as an argument (by \parsebrace or \parsearg)
5930 \def\braceorline#1{\let\macnamexxx=#1\futurelet\nchar\braceorlinexxx}
5931 \def\braceorlinexxx{%
5932 \ifx\nchar\bgroup\else
5933 \expandafter\parsearg
5934 \fi \macnamexxx}
5935
5936
5937 % @alias.
5938 % We need some trickery to remove the optional spaces around the equal
5939 % sign. Just make them active and then expand them all to nothing.
5940 \def\alias{\parseargusing\obeyspaces\aliasxxx}
5941 \def\aliasxxx #1{\aliasyyy#1\relax}
5942 \def\aliasyyy #1=#2\relax{%
5943 {%
5944 \expandafter\let\obeyedspace=\empty
5945 \addtomacrolist{#1}%
5946 \xdef\next{\global\let\makecsname{#1}=\makecsname{#2}}%
5947 }%
5948 \next
5949 }
5950
5951
5952 \message{cross references,}
5953
5954 \newwrite\auxfile
5955
5956 \newif\ifhavexrefs % True if xref values are known.
5957 \newif\ifwarnedxrefs % True if we warned once that they aren't known.
5958
5959 % @inforef is relatively simple.
5960 \def\inforef #1{\inforefzzz #1,,,,**}
5961 \def\inforefzzz #1,#2,#3,#4**{\putwordSee{} \putwordInfo{} \putwordfile{} \file{\ignorespaces #3{}},
5962 node \samp{\ignorespaces#1{}}}
5963
5964 % @node's only job in TeX is to define \lastnode, which is used in
5965 % cross-references. The @node line might or might not have commas, and
5966 % might or might not have spaces before the first comma, like:
5967 % @node foo , bar , ...
5968 % We don't want such trailing spaces in the node name.
5969 %
5970 \parseargdef\node{\checkenv{}\donode #1 ,\finishnodeparse}
5971 %
5972 % also remove a trailing comma, in case of something like this:
5973 % @node Help-Cross, , , Cross-refs
5974 \def\donode#1 ,#2\finishnodeparse{\dodonode #1,\finishnodeparse}
5975 \def\dodonode#1,#2\finishnodeparse{\gdef\lastnode{#1}}
5976
5977 \let\nwnode=\node
5978 \let\lastnode=\empty
5979
5980 % Write a cross-reference definition for the current node. #1 is the
5981 % type (Ynumbered, Yappendix, Ynothing).
5982 %
5983 \def\donoderef#1{%
5984 \ifx\lastnode\empty\else
5985 \setref{\lastnode}{#1}%
5986 \global\let\lastnode=\empty
5987 \fi
5988 }
5989
5990 % @anchor{NAME} -- define xref target at arbitrary point.
5991 %
5992 \newcount\savesfregister
5993 %
5994 \def\savesf{\relax \ifhmode \savesfregister=\spacefactor \fi}
5995 \def\restoresf{\relax \ifhmode \spacefactor=\savesfregister \fi}
5996 \def\anchor#1{\savesf \setref{#1}{Ynothing}\restoresf \ignorespaces}
5997
5998 % \setref{NAME}{SNT} defines a cross-reference point NAME (a node or an
5999 % anchor), which consists of three parts:
6000 % 1) NAME-title - the current sectioning name taken from \thissection,
6001 % or the anchor name.
6002 % 2) NAME-snt - section number and type, passed as the SNT arg, or
6003 % empty for anchors.
6004 % 3) NAME-pg - the page number.
6005 %
6006 % This is called from \donoderef, \anchor, and \dofloat. In the case of
6007 % floats, there is an additional part, which is not written here:
6008 % 4) NAME-lof - the text as it should appear in a @listoffloats.
6009 %
6010 \def\setref#1#2{%
6011 \pdfmkdest{#1}%
6012 \iflinks
6013 {%
6014 \atdummies % preserve commands, but don't expand them
6015 \edef\writexrdef##1##2{%
6016 \write\auxfile{@xrdef{#1-% #1 of \setref, expanded by the \edef
6017 ##1}{##2}}% these are parameters of \writexrdef
6018 }%
6019 \toks0 = \expandafter{\thissection}%
6020 \immediate \writexrdef{title}{\the\toks0 }%
6021 \immediate \writexrdef{snt}{\csname #2\endcsname}% \Ynumbered etc.
6022 \writexrdef{pg}{\folio}% will be written later, during \shipout
6023 }%
6024 \fi
6025 }
6026
6027 % @xref, @pxref, and @ref generate cross-references. For \xrefX, #1 is
6028 % the node name, #2 the name of the Info cross-reference, #3 the printed
6029 % node name, #4 the name of the Info file, #5 the name of the printed
6030 % manual. All but the node name can be omitted.
6031 %
6032 \def\pxref#1{\putwordsee{} \xrefX[#1,,,,,,,]}
6033 \def\xref#1{\putwordSee{} \xrefX[#1,,,,,,,]}
6034 \def\ref#1{\xrefX[#1,,,,,,,]}
6035 \def\xrefX[#1,#2,#3,#4,#5,#6]{\begingroup
6036 \unsepspaces
6037 \def\printedmanual{\ignorespaces #5}%
6038 \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #3}%
6039 \setbox1=\hbox{\printedmanual\unskip}%
6040 \setbox0=\hbox{\printedrefname\unskip}%
6041 \ifdim \wd0 = 0pt
6042 % No printed node name was explicitly given.
6043 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETxref-automatic-section-title\endcsname\relax
6044 % Use the node name inside the square brackets.
6045 \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}%
6046 \else
6047 % Use the actual chapter/section title appear inside
6048 % the square brackets. Use the real section title if we have it.
6049 \ifdim \wd1 > 0pt
6050 % It is in another manual, so we don't have it.
6051 \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}%
6052 \else
6053 \ifhavexrefs
6054 % We know the real title if we have the xref values.
6055 \def\printedrefname{\refx{#1-title}{}}%
6056 \else
6057 % Otherwise just copy the Info node name.
6058 \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}%
6059 \fi%
6060 \fi
6061 \fi
6062 \fi
6063 %
6064 % Make link in pdf output.
6065 \ifpdf
6066 \leavevmode
6067 \getfilename{#4}%
6068 {\turnoffactive
6069 % See comments at \activebackslashdouble.
6070 {\activebackslashdouble \xdef\pdfxrefdest{#1}%
6071 \backslashparens\pdfxrefdest}%
6072 %
6073 \ifnum\filenamelength>0
6074 \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]}%
6075 goto file{\the\filename.pdf} name{\pdfxrefdest}%
6076 \else
6077 \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]}%
6078 goto name{\pdfmkpgn{\pdfxrefdest}}%
6079 \fi
6080 }%
6081 \linkcolor
6082 \fi
6083 %
6084 % Float references are printed completely differently: "Figure 1.2"
6085 % instead of "[somenode], p.3". We distinguish them by the
6086 % LABEL-title being set to a magic string.
6087 {%
6088 % Have to otherify everything special to allow the \csname to
6089 % include an _ in the xref name, etc.
6090 \indexnofonts
6091 \turnoffactive
6092 \expandafter\global\expandafter\let\expandafter\Xthisreftitle
6093 \csname XR#1-title\endcsname
6094 }%
6095 \iffloat\Xthisreftitle
6096 % If the user specified the print name (third arg) to the ref,
6097 % print it instead of our usual "Figure 1.2".
6098 \ifdim\wd0 = 0pt
6099 \refx{#1-snt}{}%
6100 \else
6101 \printedrefname
6102 \fi
6103 %
6104 % if the user also gave the printed manual name (fifth arg), append
6105 % "in MANUALNAME".
6106 \ifdim \wd1 > 0pt
6107 \space \putwordin{} \cite{\printedmanual}%
6108 \fi
6109 \else
6110 % node/anchor (non-float) references.
6111 %
6112 % If we use \unhbox0 and \unhbox1 to print the node names, TeX does not
6113 % insert empty discretionaries after hyphens, which means that it will
6114 % not find a line break at a hyphen in a node names. Since some manuals
6115 % are best written with fairly long node names, containing hyphens, this
6116 % is a loss. Therefore, we give the text of the node name again, so it
6117 % is as if TeX is seeing it for the first time.
6118 \ifdim \wd1 > 0pt
6119 \putwordsection{} ``\printedrefname'' \putwordin{} \cite{\printedmanual}%
6120 \else
6121 % _ (for example) has to be the character _ for the purposes of the
6122 % control sequence corresponding to the node, but it has to expand
6123 % into the usual \leavevmode...\vrule stuff for purposes of
6124 % printing. So we \turnoffactive for the \refx-snt, back on for the
6125 % printing, back off for the \refx-pg.
6126 {\turnoffactive
6127 % Only output a following space if the -snt ref is nonempty; for
6128 % @unnumbered and @anchor, it won't be.
6129 \setbox2 = \hbox{\ignorespaces \refx{#1-snt}{}}%
6130 \ifdim \wd2 > 0pt \refx{#1-snt}\space\fi
6131 }%
6132 % output the `[mynode]' via a macro so it can be overridden.
6133 \xrefprintnodename\printedrefname
6134 %
6135 % But we always want a comma and a space:
6136 ,\space
6137 %
6138 % output the `page 3'.
6139 \turnoffactive \putwordpage\tie\refx{#1-pg}{}%
6140 \fi
6141 \fi
6142 \endlink
6143 \endgroup}
6144
6145 % This macro is called from \xrefX for the `[nodename]' part of xref
6146 % output. It's a separate macro only so it can be changed more easily,
6147 % since square brackets don't work well in some documents. Particularly
6148 % one that Bob is working on :).
6149 %
6150 \def\xrefprintnodename#1{[#1]}
6151
6152 % Things referred to by \setref.
6153 %
6154 \def\Ynothing{}
6155 \def\Yomitfromtoc{}
6156 \def\Ynumbered{%
6157 \ifnum\secno=0
6158 \putwordChapter@tie \the\chapno
6159 \else \ifnum\subsecno=0
6160 \putwordSection@tie \the\chapno.\the\secno
6161 \else \ifnum\subsubsecno=0
6162 \putwordSection@tie \the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno
6163 \else
6164 \putwordSection@tie \the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno
6165 \fi\fi\fi
6166 }
6167 \def\Yappendix{%
6168 \ifnum\secno=0
6169 \putwordAppendix@tie @char\the\appendixno{}%
6170 \else \ifnum\subsecno=0
6171 \putwordSection@tie @char\the\appendixno.\the\secno
6172 \else \ifnum\subsubsecno=0
6173 \putwordSection@tie @char\the\appendixno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno
6174 \else
6175 \putwordSection@tie
6176 @char\the\appendixno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno
6177 \fi\fi\fi
6178 }
6179
6180 % Define \refx{NAME}{SUFFIX} to reference a cross-reference string named NAME.
6181 % If its value is nonempty, SUFFIX is output afterward.
6182 %
6183 \def\refx#1#2{%
6184 {%
6185 \indexnofonts
6186 \otherbackslash
6187 \expandafter\global\expandafter\let\expandafter\thisrefX
6188 \csname XR#1\endcsname
6189 }%
6190 \ifx\thisrefX\relax
6191 % If not defined, say something at least.
6192 \angleleft un\-de\-fined\angleright
6193 \iflinks
6194 \ifhavexrefs
6195 \message{\linenumber Undefined cross reference `#1'.}%
6196 \else
6197 \ifwarnedxrefs\else
6198 \global\warnedxrefstrue
6199 \message{Cross reference values unknown; you must run TeX again.}%
6200 \fi
6201 \fi
6202 \fi
6203 \else
6204 % It's defined, so just use it.
6205 \thisrefX
6206 \fi
6207 #2% Output the suffix in any case.
6208 }
6209
6210 % This is the macro invoked by entries in the aux file. Usually it's
6211 % just a \def (we prepend XR to the control sequence name to avoid
6212 % collisions). But if this is a float type, we have more work to do.
6213 %
6214 \def\xrdef#1#2{%
6215 \expandafter\gdef\csname XR#1\endcsname{#2}% remember this xref value.
6216 %
6217 % Was that xref control sequence that we just defined for a float?
6218 \expandafter\iffloat\csname XR#1\endcsname
6219 % it was a float, and we have the (safe) float type in \iffloattype.
6220 \expandafter\let\expandafter\floatlist
6221 \csname floatlist\iffloattype\endcsname
6222 %
6223 % Is this the first time we've seen this float type?
6224 \expandafter\ifx\floatlist\relax
6225 \toks0 = {\do}% yes, so just \do
6226 \else
6227 % had it before, so preserve previous elements in list.
6228 \toks0 = \expandafter{\floatlist\do}%
6229 \fi
6230 %
6231 % Remember this xref in the control sequence \floatlistFLOATTYPE,
6232 % for later use in \listoffloats.
6233 \expandafter\xdef\csname floatlist\iffloattype\endcsname{\the\toks0{#1}}%
6234 \fi
6235 }
6236
6237 % Read the last existing aux file, if any. No error if none exists.
6238 %
6239 \def\tryauxfile{%
6240 \openin 1 \jobname.aux
6241 \ifeof 1 \else
6242 \readdatafile{aux}%
6243 \global\havexrefstrue
6244 \fi
6245 \closein 1
6246 }
6247
6248 \def\setupdatafile{%
6249 \catcode`\^^@=\other
6250 \catcode`\^^A=\other
6251 \catcode`\^^B=\other
6252 \catcode`\^^C=\other
6253 \catcode`\^^D=\other
6254 \catcode`\^^E=\other
6255 \catcode`\^^F=\other
6256 \catcode`\^^G=\other
6257 \catcode`\^^H=\other
6258 \catcode`\^^K=\other
6259 \catcode`\^^L=\other
6260 \catcode`\^^N=\other
6261 \catcode`\^^P=\other
6262 \catcode`\^^Q=\other
6263 \catcode`\^^R=\other
6264 \catcode`\^^S=\other
6265 \catcode`\^^T=\other
6266 \catcode`\^^U=\other
6267 \catcode`\^^V=\other
6268 \catcode`\^^W=\other
6269 \catcode`\^^X=\other
6270 \catcode`\^^Z=\other
6271 \catcode`\^^[=\other
6272 \catcode`\^^\=\other
6273 \catcode`\^^]=\other
6274 \catcode`\^^^=\other
6275 \catcode`\^^_=\other
6276 % It was suggested to set the catcode of ^ to 7, which would allow ^^e4 etc.
6277 % in xref tags, i.e., node names. But since ^^e4 notation isn't
6278 % supported in the main text, it doesn't seem desirable. Furthermore,
6279 % that is not enough: for node names that actually contain a ^
6280 % character, we would end up writing a line like this: 'xrdef {'hat
6281 % b-title}{'hat b} and \xrdef does a \csname...\endcsname on the first
6282 % argument, and \hat is not an expandable control sequence. It could
6283 % all be worked out, but why? Either we support ^^ or we don't.
6284 %
6285 % The other change necessary for this was to define \auxhat:
6286 % \def\auxhat{\def^{'hat }}% extra space so ok if followed by letter
6287 % and then to call \auxhat in \setq.
6288 %
6289 \catcode`\^=\other
6290 %
6291 % Special characters. Should be turned off anyway, but...
6292 \catcode`\~=\other
6293 \catcode`\[=\other
6294 \catcode`\]=\other
6295 \catcode`\"=\other
6296 \catcode`\_=\other
6297 \catcode`\|=\other
6298 \catcode`\<=\other
6299 \catcode`\>=\other
6300 \catcode`\$=\other
6301 \catcode`\#=\other
6302 \catcode`\&=\other
6303 \catcode`\%=\other
6304 \catcode`+=\other % avoid \+ for paranoia even though we've turned it off
6305 %
6306 % This is to support \ in node names and titles, since the \
6307 % characters end up in a \csname. It's easier than
6308 % leaving it active and making its active definition an actual \
6309 % character. What I don't understand is why it works in the *value*
6310 % of the xrdef. Seems like it should be a catcode12 \, and that
6311 % should not typeset properly. But it works, so I'm moving on for
6312 % now. --karl, 15jan04.
6313 \catcode`\\=\other
6314 %
6315 % Make the characters 128-255 be printing characters.
6316 {%
6317 \count1=128
6318 \def\loop{%
6319 \catcode\count1=\other
6320 \advance\count1 by 1
6321 \ifnum \count1<256 \loop \fi
6322 }%
6323 }%
6324 %
6325 % @ is our escape character in .aux files, and we need braces.
6326 \catcode`\{=1
6327 \catcode`\}=2
6328 \catcode`\@=0
6329 }
6330
6331 \def\readdatafile#1{%
6332 \begingroup
6333 \setupdatafile
6334 \input\jobname.#1
6335 \endgroup}
6336
6337 \message{insertions,}
6338 % including footnotes.
6339
6340 \newcount \footnoteno
6341
6342 % The trailing space in the following definition for supereject is
6343 % vital for proper filling; pages come out unaligned when you do a
6344 % pagealignmacro call if that space before the closing brace is
6345 % removed. (Generally, numeric constants should always be followed by a
6346 % space to prevent strange expansion errors.)
6347 \def\supereject{\par\penalty -20000\footnoteno =0 }
6348
6349 % @footnotestyle is meaningful for info output only.
6350 \let\footnotestyle=\comment
6351
6352 {\catcode `\@=11
6353 %
6354 % Auto-number footnotes. Otherwise like plain.
6355 \gdef\footnote{%
6356 \let\indent=\ptexindent
6357 \let\noindent=\ptexnoindent
6358 \global\advance\footnoteno by \@ne
6359 \edef\thisfootno{$^{\the\footnoteno}$}%
6360 %
6361 % In case the footnote comes at the end of a sentence, preserve the
6362 % extra spacing after we do the footnote number.
6363 \let\@sf\empty
6364 \ifhmode\edef\@sf{\spacefactor\the\spacefactor}\ptexslash\fi
6365 %
6366 % Remove inadvertent blank space before typesetting the footnote number.
6367 \unskip
6368 \thisfootno\@sf
6369 \dofootnote
6370 }%
6371
6372 % Don't bother with the trickery in plain.tex to not require the
6373 % footnote text as a parameter. Our footnotes don't need to be so general.
6374 %
6375 % Oh yes, they do; otherwise, @ifset (and anything else that uses
6376 % \parseargline) fails inside footnotes because the tokens are fixed when
6377 % the footnote is read. --karl, 16nov96.
6378 %
6379 \gdef\dofootnote{%
6380 \insert\footins\bgroup
6381 % We want to typeset this text as a normal paragraph, even if the
6382 % footnote reference occurs in (for example) a display environment.
6383 % So reset some parameters.
6384 \hsize=\pagewidth
6385 \interlinepenalty\interfootnotelinepenalty
6386 \splittopskip\ht\strutbox % top baseline for broken footnotes
6387 \splitmaxdepth\dp\strutbox
6388 \floatingpenalty\@MM
6389 \leftskip\z@skip
6390 \rightskip\z@skip
6391 \spaceskip\z@skip
6392 \xspaceskip\z@skip
6393 \parindent\defaultparindent
6394 %
6395 \smallfonts \rm
6396 %
6397 % Because we use hanging indentation in footnotes, a @noindent appears
6398 % to exdent this text, so make it be a no-op. makeinfo does not use
6399 % hanging indentation so @noindent can still be needed within footnote
6400 % text after an @example or the like (not that this is good style).
6401 \let\noindent = \relax
6402 %
6403 % Hang the footnote text off the number. Use \everypar in case the
6404 % footnote extends for more than one paragraph.
6405 \everypar = {\hang}%
6406 \textindent{\thisfootno}%
6407 %
6408 % Don't crash into the line above the footnote text. Since this
6409 % expands into a box, it must come within the paragraph, lest it
6410 % provide a place where TeX can split the footnote.
6411 \footstrut
6412 \futurelet\next\fo@t
6413 }
6414 }%end \catcode `\@=11
6415
6416 % In case a @footnote appears in a vbox, save the footnote text and create
6417 % the real \insert just after the vbox finished. Otherwise, the insertion
6418 % would be lost.
6419 % Similarily, if a @footnote appears inside an alignment, save the footnote
6420 % text to a box and make the \insert when a row of the table is finished.
6421 % And the same can be done for other insert classes. --kasal, 16nov03.
6422
6423 % Replace the \insert primitive by a cheating macro.
6424 % Deeper inside, just make sure that the saved insertions are not spilled
6425 % out prematurely.
6426 %
6427 \def\startsavinginserts{%
6428 \ifx \insert\ptexinsert
6429 \let\insert\saveinsert
6430 \else
6431 \let\checkinserts\relax
6432 \fi
6433 }
6434
6435 % This \insert replacement works for both \insert\footins{foo} and
6436 % \insert\footins\bgroup foo\egroup, but it doesn't work for \insert27{foo}.
6437 %
6438 \def\saveinsert#1{%
6439 \edef\next{\noexpand\savetobox \makeSAVEname#1}%
6440 \afterassignment\next
6441 % swallow the left brace
6442 \let\temp =
6443 }
6444 \def\makeSAVEname#1{\makecsname{SAVE\expandafter\gobble\string#1}}
6445 \def\savetobox#1{\global\setbox#1 = \vbox\bgroup \unvbox#1}
6446
6447 \def\checksaveins#1{\ifvoid#1\else \placesaveins#1\fi}
6448
6449 \def\placesaveins#1{%
6450 \ptexinsert \csname\expandafter\gobblesave\string#1\endcsname
6451 {\box#1}%
6452 }
6453
6454 % eat @SAVE -- beware, all of them have catcode \other:
6455 {
6456 \def\dospecials{\do S\do A\do V\do E} \uncatcodespecials % ;-)
6457 \gdef\gobblesave @SAVE{}
6458 }
6459
6460 % initialization:
6461 \def\newsaveins #1{%
6462 \edef\next{\noexpand\newsaveinsX \makeSAVEname#1}%
6463 \next
6464 }
6465 \def\newsaveinsX #1{%
6466 \csname newbox\endcsname #1%
6467 \expandafter\def\expandafter\checkinserts\expandafter{\checkinserts
6468 \checksaveins #1}%
6469 }
6470
6471 % initialize:
6472 \let\checkinserts\empty
6473 \newsaveins\footins
6474 \newsaveins\margin
6475
6476
6477 % @image. We use the macros from epsf.tex to support this.
6478 % If epsf.tex is not installed and @image is used, we complain.
6479 %
6480 % Check for and read epsf.tex up front. If we read it only at @image
6481 % time, we might be inside a group, and then its definitions would get
6482 % undone and the next image would fail.
6483 \openin 1 = epsf.tex
6484 \ifeof 1 \else
6485 % Do not bother showing banner with epsf.tex v2.7k (available in
6486 % doc/epsf.tex and on ctan).
6487 \def\epsfannounce{\toks0 = }%
6488 \input epsf.tex
6489 \fi
6490 \closein 1
6491 %
6492 % We will only complain once about lack of epsf.tex.
6493 \newif\ifwarnednoepsf
6494 \newhelp\noepsfhelp{epsf.tex must be installed for images to
6495 work. It is also included in the Texinfo distribution, or you can get
6496 it from ftp://tug.org/tex/epsf.tex.}
6497 %
6498 \def\image#1{%
6499 \ifx\epsfbox\undefined
6500 \ifwarnednoepsf \else
6501 \errhelp = \noepsfhelp
6502 \errmessage{epsf.tex not found, images will be ignored}%
6503 \global\warnednoepsftrue
6504 \fi
6505 \else
6506 \imagexxx #1,,,,,\finish
6507 \fi
6508 }
6509 %
6510 % Arguments to @image:
6511 % #1 is (mandatory) image filename; we tack on .eps extension.
6512 % #2 is (optional) width, #3 is (optional) height.
6513 % #4 is (ignored optional) html alt text.
6514 % #5 is (ignored optional) extension.
6515 % #6 is just the usual extra ignored arg for parsing this stuff.
6516 \newif\ifimagevmode
6517 \def\imagexxx#1,#2,#3,#4,#5,#6\finish{\begingroup
6518 \catcode`\^^M = 5 % in case we're inside an example
6519 \normalturnoffactive % allow _ et al. in names
6520 % If the image is by itself, center it.
6521 \ifvmode
6522 \imagevmodetrue
6523 \nobreak\bigskip
6524 % Usually we'll have text after the image which will insert
6525 % \parskip glue, so insert it here too to equalize the space
6526 % above and below.
6527 \nobreak\vskip\parskip
6528 \nobreak
6529 \line\bgroup
6530 \fi
6531 %
6532 % Output the image.
6533 \ifpdf
6534 \dopdfimage{#1}{#2}{#3}%
6535 \else
6536 % \epsfbox itself resets \epsf?size at each figure.
6537 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}\ifdim\wd0 > 0pt \epsfxsize=#2\relax \fi
6538 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #3}\ifdim\wd0 > 0pt \epsfysize=#3\relax \fi
6539 \epsfbox{#1.eps}%
6540 \fi
6541 %
6542 \ifimagevmode \egroup \bigbreak \fi % space after the image
6543 \endgroup}
6544
6545
6546 % @float FLOATTYPE,LABEL,LOC ... @end float for displayed figures, tables,
6547 % etc. We don't actually implement floating yet, we always include the
6548 % float "here". But it seemed the best name for the future.
6549 %
6550 \envparseargdef\float{\eatcommaspace\eatcommaspace\dofloat#1, , ,\finish}
6551
6552 % There may be a space before second and/or third parameter; delete it.
6553 \def\eatcommaspace#1, {#1,}
6554
6555 % #1 is the optional FLOATTYPE, the text label for this float, typically
6556 % "Figure", "Table", "Example", etc. Can't contain commas. If omitted,
6557 % this float will not be numbered and cannot be referred to.
6558 %
6559 % #2 is the optional xref label. Also must be present for the float to
6560 % be referable.
6561 %
6562 % #3 is the optional positioning argument; for now, it is ignored. It
6563 % will somehow specify the positions allowed to float to (here, top, bottom).
6564 %
6565 % We keep a separate counter for each FLOATTYPE, which we reset at each
6566 % chapter-level command.
6567 \let\resetallfloatnos=\empty
6568 %
6569 \def\dofloat#1,#2,#3,#4\finish{%
6570 \let\thiscaption=\empty
6571 \let\thisshortcaption=\empty
6572 %
6573 % don't lose footnotes inside @float.
6574 %
6575 % BEWARE: when the floats start float, we have to issue warning whenever an
6576 % insert appears inside a float which could possibly float. --kasal, 26may04
6577 %
6578 \startsavinginserts
6579 %
6580 % We can't be used inside a paragraph.
6581 \par
6582 %
6583 \vtop\bgroup
6584 \def\floattype{#1}%
6585 \def\floatlabel{#2}%
6586 \def\floatloc{#3}% we do nothing with this yet.
6587 %
6588 \ifx\floattype\empty
6589 \let\safefloattype=\empty
6590 \else
6591 {%
6592 % the floattype might have accents or other special characters,
6593 % but we need to use it in a control sequence name.
6594 \indexnofonts
6595 \turnoffactive
6596 \xdef\safefloattype{\floattype}%
6597 }%
6598 \fi
6599 %
6600 % If label is given but no type, we handle that as the empty type.
6601 \ifx\floatlabel\empty \else
6602 % We want each FLOATTYPE to be numbered separately (Figure 1,
6603 % Table 1, Figure 2, ...). (And if no label, no number.)
6604 %
6605 \expandafter\getfloatno\csname\safefloattype floatno\endcsname
6606 \global\advance\floatno by 1
6607 %
6608 {%
6609 % This magic value for \thissection is output by \setref as the
6610 % XREFLABEL-title value. \xrefX uses it to distinguish float
6611 % labels (which have a completely different output format) from
6612 % node and anchor labels. And \xrdef uses it to construct the
6613 % lists of floats.
6614 %
6615 \edef\thissection{\floatmagic=\safefloattype}%
6616 \setref{\floatlabel}{Yfloat}%
6617 }%
6618 \fi
6619 %
6620 % start with \parskip glue, I guess.
6621 \vskip\parskip
6622 %
6623 % Don't suppress indentation if a float happens to start a section.
6624 \restorefirstparagraphindent
6625 }
6626
6627 % we have these possibilities:
6628 % @float Foo,lbl & @caption{Cap}: Foo 1.1: Cap
6629 % @float Foo,lbl & no caption: Foo 1.1
6630 % @float Foo & @caption{Cap}: Foo: Cap
6631 % @float Foo & no caption: Foo
6632 % @float ,lbl & Caption{Cap}: 1.1: Cap
6633 % @float ,lbl & no caption: 1.1
6634 % @float & @caption{Cap}: Cap
6635 % @float & no caption:
6636 %
6637 \def\Efloat{%
6638 \let\floatident = \empty
6639 %
6640 % In all cases, if we have a float type, it comes first.
6641 \ifx\floattype\empty \else \def\floatident{\floattype}\fi
6642 %
6643 % If we have an xref label, the number comes next.
6644 \ifx\floatlabel\empty \else
6645 \ifx\floattype\empty \else % if also had float type, need tie first.
6646 \appendtomacro\floatident{\tie}%
6647 \fi
6648 % the number.
6649 \appendtomacro\floatident{\chaplevelprefix\the\floatno}%
6650 \fi
6651 %
6652 % Start the printed caption with what we've constructed in
6653 % \floatident, but keep it separate; we need \floatident again.
6654 \let\captionline = \floatident
6655 %
6656 \ifx\thiscaption\empty \else
6657 \ifx\floatident\empty \else
6658 \appendtomacro\captionline{: }% had ident, so need a colon between
6659 \fi
6660 %
6661 % caption text.
6662 \appendtomacro\captionline{\scanexp\thiscaption}%
6663 \fi
6664 %
6665 % If we have anything to print, print it, with space before.
6666 % Eventually this needs to become an \insert.
6667 \ifx\captionline\empty \else
6668 \vskip.5\parskip
6669 \captionline
6670 %
6671 % Space below caption.
6672 \vskip\parskip
6673 \fi
6674 %
6675 % If have an xref label, write the list of floats info. Do this
6676 % after the caption, to avoid chance of it being a breakpoint.
6677 \ifx\floatlabel\empty \else
6678 % Write the text that goes in the lof to the aux file as
6679 % \floatlabel-lof. Besides \floatident, we include the short
6680 % caption if specified, else the full caption if specified, else nothing.
6681 {%
6682 \atdummies
6683 %
6684 % since we read the caption text in the macro world, where ^^M
6685 % is turned into a normal character, we have to scan it back, so
6686 % we don't write the literal three characters "^^M" into the aux file.
6687 \scanexp{%
6688 \xdef\noexpand\gtemp{%
6689 \ifx\thisshortcaption\empty
6690 \thiscaption
6691 \else
6692 \thisshortcaption
6693 \fi
6694 }%
6695 }%
6696 \immediate\write\auxfile{@xrdef{\floatlabel-lof}{\floatident
6697 \ifx\gtemp\empty \else : \gtemp \fi}}%
6698 }%
6699 \fi
6700 \egroup % end of \vtop
6701 %
6702 % place the captured inserts
6703 %
6704 % BEWARE: when the floats start floating, we have to issue warning
6705 % whenever an insert appears inside a float which could possibly
6706 % float. --kasal, 26may04
6707 %
6708 \checkinserts
6709 }
6710
6711 % Append the tokens #2 to the definition of macro #1, not expanding either.
6712 %
6713 \def\appendtomacro#1#2{%
6714 \expandafter\def\expandafter#1\expandafter{#1#2}%
6715 }
6716
6717 % @caption, @shortcaption
6718 %
6719 \def\caption{\docaption\thiscaption}
6720 \def\shortcaption{\docaption\thisshortcaption}
6721 \def\docaption{\checkenv\float \bgroup\scanargctxt\defcaption}
6722 \def\defcaption#1#2{\egroup \def#1{#2}}
6723
6724 % The parameter is the control sequence identifying the counter we are
6725 % going to use. Create it if it doesn't exist and assign it to \floatno.
6726 \def\getfloatno#1{%
6727 \ifx#1\relax
6728 % Haven't seen this figure type before.
6729 \csname newcount\endcsname #1%
6730 %
6731 % Remember to reset this floatno at the next chap.
6732 \expandafter\gdef\expandafter\resetallfloatnos
6733 \expandafter{\resetallfloatnos #1=0 }%
6734 \fi
6735 \let\floatno#1%
6736 }
6737
6738 % \setref calls this to get the XREFLABEL-snt value. We want an @xref
6739 % to the FLOATLABEL to expand to "Figure 3.1". We call \setref when we
6740 % first read the @float command.
6741 %
6742 \def\Yfloat{\floattype@tie \chaplevelprefix\the\floatno}%
6743
6744 % Magic string used for the XREFLABEL-title value, so \xrefX can
6745 % distinguish floats from other xref types.
6746 \def\floatmagic{!!float!!}
6747
6748 % #1 is the control sequence we are passed; we expand into a conditional
6749 % which is true if #1 represents a float ref. That is, the magic
6750 % \thissection value which we \setref above.
6751 %
6752 \def\iffloat#1{\expandafter\doiffloat#1==\finish}
6753 %
6754 % #1 is (maybe) the \floatmagic string. If so, #2 will be the
6755 % (safe) float type for this float. We set \iffloattype to #2.
6756 %
6757 \def\doiffloat#1=#2=#3\finish{%
6758 \def\temp{#1}%
6759 \def\iffloattype{#2}%
6760 \ifx\temp\floatmagic
6761 }
6762
6763 % @listoffloats FLOATTYPE - print a list of floats like a table of contents.
6764 %
6765 \parseargdef\listoffloats{%
6766 \def\floattype{#1}% floattype
6767 {%
6768 % the floattype might have accents or other special characters,
6769 % but we need to use it in a control sequence name.
6770 \indexnofonts
6771 \turnoffactive
6772 \xdef\safefloattype{\floattype}%
6773 }%
6774 %
6775 % \xrdef saves the floats as a \do-list in \floatlistSAFEFLOATTYPE.
6776 \expandafter\ifx\csname floatlist\safefloattype\endcsname \relax
6777 \ifhavexrefs
6778 % if the user said @listoffloats foo but never @float foo.
6779 \message{\linenumber No `\safefloattype' floats to list.}%
6780 \fi
6781 \else
6782 \begingroup
6783 \leftskip=\tocindent % indent these entries like a toc
6784 \let\do=\listoffloatsdo
6785 \csname floatlist\safefloattype\endcsname
6786 \endgroup
6787 \fi
6788 }
6789
6790 % This is called on each entry in a list of floats. We're passed the
6791 % xref label, in the form LABEL-title, which is how we save it in the
6792 % aux file. We strip off the -title and look up \XRLABEL-lof, which
6793 % has the text we're supposed to typeset here.
6794 %
6795 % Figures without xref labels will not be included in the list (since
6796 % they won't appear in the aux file).
6797 %
6798 \def\listoffloatsdo#1{\listoffloatsdoentry#1\finish}
6799 \def\listoffloatsdoentry#1-title\finish{{%
6800 % Can't fully expand XR#1-lof because it can contain anything. Just
6801 % pass the control sequence. On the other hand, XR#1-pg is just the
6802 % page number, and we want to fully expand that so we can get a link
6803 % in pdf output.
6804 \toksA = \expandafter{\csname XR#1-lof\endcsname}%
6805 %
6806 % use the same \entry macro we use to generate the TOC and index.
6807 \edef\writeentry{\noexpand\entry{\the\toksA}{\csname XR#1-pg\endcsname}}%
6808 \writeentry
6809 }}
6810
6811 \message{localization,}
6812 % and i18n.
6813
6814 % @documentlanguage is usually given very early, just after
6815 % @setfilename. If done too late, it may not override everything
6816 % properly. Single argument is the language abbreviation.
6817 % It would be nice if we could set up a hyphenation file here.
6818 %
6819 \parseargdef\documentlanguage{%
6820 \tex % read txi-??.tex file in plain TeX.
6821 % Read the file if it exists.
6822 \openin 1 txi-#1.tex
6823 \ifeof 1
6824 \errhelp = \nolanghelp
6825 \errmessage{Cannot read language file txi-#1.tex}%
6826 \else
6827 \input txi-#1.tex
6828 \fi
6829 \closein 1
6830 \endgroup
6831 }
6832 \newhelp\nolanghelp{The given language definition file cannot be found or
6833 is empty. Maybe you need to install it? In the current directory
6834 should work if nowhere else does.}
6835
6836
6837 % @documentencoding should change something in TeX eventually, most
6838 % likely, but for now just recognize it.
6839 \let\documentencoding = \comment
6840
6841
6842 % Page size parameters.
6843 %
6844 \newdimen\defaultparindent \defaultparindent = 15pt
6845
6846 \chapheadingskip = 15pt plus 4pt minus 2pt
6847 \secheadingskip = 12pt plus 3pt minus 2pt
6848 \subsecheadingskip = 9pt plus 2pt minus 2pt
6849
6850 % Prevent underfull vbox error messages.
6851 \vbadness = 10000
6852
6853 % Don't be so finicky about underfull hboxes, either.
6854 \hbadness = 2000
6855
6856 % Following George Bush, just get rid of widows and orphans.
6857 \widowpenalty=10000
6858 \clubpenalty=10000
6859
6860 % Use TeX 3.0's \emergencystretch to help line breaking, but if we're
6861 % using an old version of TeX, don't do anything. We want the amount of
6862 % stretch added to depend on the line length, hence the dependence on
6863 % \hsize. We call this whenever the paper size is set.
6864 %
6865 \def\setemergencystretch{%
6866 \ifx\emergencystretch\thisisundefined
6867 % Allow us to assign to \emergencystretch anyway.
6868 \def\emergencystretch{\dimen0}%
6869 \else
6870 \emergencystretch = .15\hsize
6871 \fi
6872 }
6873
6874 % Parameters in order: 1) textheight; 2) textwidth;
6875 % 3) voffset; 4) hoffset; 5) binding offset; 6) topskip;
6876 % 7) physical page height; 8) physical page width.
6877 %
6878 % We also call \setleading{\textleading}, so the caller should define
6879 % \textleading. The caller should also set \parskip.
6880 %
6881 \def\internalpagesizes#1#2#3#4#5#6#7#8{%
6882 \voffset = #3\relax
6883 \topskip = #6\relax
6884 \splittopskip = \topskip
6885 %
6886 \vsize = #1\relax
6887 \advance\vsize by \topskip
6888 \outervsize = \vsize
6889 \advance\outervsize by 2\topandbottommargin
6890 \pageheight = \vsize
6891 %
6892 \hsize = #2\relax
6893 \outerhsize = \hsize
6894 \advance\outerhsize by 0.5in
6895 \pagewidth = \hsize
6896 %
6897 \normaloffset = #4\relax
6898 \bindingoffset = #5\relax
6899 %
6900 \ifpdf
6901 \pdfpageheight #7\relax
6902 \pdfpagewidth #8\relax
6903 \fi
6904 %
6905 \setleading{\textleading}
6906 %
6907 \parindent = \defaultparindent
6908 \setemergencystretch
6909 }
6910
6911 % @letterpaper (the default).
6912 \def\letterpaper{{\globaldefs = 1
6913 \parskip = 3pt plus 2pt minus 1pt
6914 \textleading = 13.2pt
6915 %
6916 % If page is nothing but text, make it come out even.
6917 \internalpagesizes{46\baselineskip}{6in}%
6918 {\voffset}{.25in}%
6919 {\bindingoffset}{36pt}%
6920 {11in}{8.5in}%
6921 }}
6922
6923 % Use @smallbook to reset parameters for 7x9.25 trim size.
6924 \def\smallbook{{\globaldefs = 1
6925 \parskip = 2pt plus 1pt
6926 \textleading = 12pt
6927 %
6928 \internalpagesizes{7.5in}{5in}%
6929 {\voffset}{.25in}%
6930 {\bindingoffset}{16pt}%
6931 {9.25in}{7in}%
6932 %
6933 \lispnarrowing = 0.3in
6934 \tolerance = 700
6935 \hfuzz = 1pt
6936 \contentsrightmargin = 0pt
6937 \defbodyindent = .5cm
6938 }}
6939
6940 % Use @smallerbook to reset parameters for 6x9 trim size.
6941 % (Just testing, parameters still in flux.)
6942 \def\smallerbook{{\globaldefs = 1
6943 \parskip = 1.5pt plus 1pt
6944 \textleading = 12pt
6945 %
6946 \internalpagesizes{7.4in}{4.8in}%
6947 {-.2in}{-.4in}%
6948 {0pt}{14pt}%
6949 {9in}{6in}%
6950 %
6951 \lispnarrowing = 0.25in
6952 \tolerance = 700
6953 \hfuzz = 1pt
6954 \contentsrightmargin = 0pt
6955 \defbodyindent = .4cm
6956 }}
6957
6958 % Use @afourpaper to print on European A4 paper.
6959 \def\afourpaper{{\globaldefs = 1
6960 \parskip = 3pt plus 2pt minus 1pt
6961 \textleading = 13.2pt
6962 %
6963 % Double-side printing via postscript on Laserjet 4050
6964 % prints double-sided nicely when \bindingoffset=10mm and \hoffset=-6mm.
6965 % To change the settings for a different printer or situation, adjust
6966 % \normaloffset until the front-side and back-side texts align. Then
6967 % do the same for \bindingoffset. You can set these for testing in
6968 % your texinfo source file like this:
6969 % @tex
6970 % \global\normaloffset = -6mm
6971 % \global\bindingoffset = 10mm
6972 % @end tex
6973 \internalpagesizes{51\baselineskip}{160mm}
6974 {\voffset}{\hoffset}%
6975 {\bindingoffset}{44pt}%
6976 {297mm}{210mm}%
6977 %
6978 \tolerance = 700
6979 \hfuzz = 1pt
6980 \contentsrightmargin = 0pt
6981 \defbodyindent = 5mm
6982 }}
6983
6984 % Use @afivepaper to print on European A5 paper.
6985 % From romildo@urano.iceb.ufop.br, 2 July 2000.
6986 % He also recommends making @example and @lisp be small.
6987 \def\afivepaper{{\globaldefs = 1
6988 \parskip = 2pt plus 1pt minus 0.1pt
6989 \textleading = 12.5pt
6990 %
6991 \internalpagesizes{160mm}{120mm}%
6992 {\voffset}{\hoffset}%
6993 {\bindingoffset}{8pt}%
6994 {210mm}{148mm}%
6995 %
6996 \lispnarrowing = 0.2in
6997 \tolerance = 800
6998 \hfuzz = 1.2pt
6999 \contentsrightmargin = 0pt
7000 \defbodyindent = 2mm
7001 \tableindent = 12mm
7002 }}
7003
7004 % A specific text layout, 24x15cm overall, intended for A4 paper.
7005 \def\afourlatex{{\globaldefs = 1
7006 \afourpaper
7007 \internalpagesizes{237mm}{150mm}%
7008 {\voffset}{4.6mm}%
7009 {\bindingoffset}{7mm}%
7010 {297mm}{210mm}%
7011 %
7012 % Must explicitly reset to 0 because we call \afourpaper.
7013 \globaldefs = 0
7014 }}
7015
7016 % Use @afourwide to print on A4 paper in landscape format.
7017 \def\afourwide{{\globaldefs = 1
7018 \afourpaper
7019 \internalpagesizes{241mm}{165mm}%
7020 {\voffset}{-2.95mm}%
7021 {\bindingoffset}{7mm}%
7022 {297mm}{210mm}%
7023 \globaldefs = 0
7024 }}
7025
7026 % @pagesizes TEXTHEIGHT[,TEXTWIDTH]
7027 % Perhaps we should allow setting the margins, \topskip, \parskip,
7028 % and/or leading, also. Or perhaps we should compute them somehow.
7029 %
7030 \parseargdef\pagesizes{\pagesizesyyy #1,,\finish}
7031 \def\pagesizesyyy#1,#2,#3\finish{{%
7032 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}\ifdim\wd0 > 0pt \hsize=#2\relax \fi
7033 \globaldefs = 1
7034 %
7035 \parskip = 3pt plus 2pt minus 1pt
7036 \setleading{\textleading}%
7037 %
7038 \dimen0 = #1
7039 \advance\dimen0 by \voffset
7040 %
7041 \dimen2 = \hsize
7042 \advance\dimen2 by \normaloffset
7043 %
7044 \internalpagesizes{#1}{\hsize}%
7045 {\voffset}{\normaloffset}%
7046 {\bindingoffset}{44pt}%
7047 {\dimen0}{\dimen2}%
7048 }}
7049
7050 % Set default to letter.
7051 %
7052 \letterpaper
7053
7054
7055 \message{and turning on texinfo input format.}
7056
7057 % Define macros to output various characters with catcode for normal text.
7058 \catcode`\"=\other
7059 \catcode`\~=\other
7060 \catcode`\^=\other
7061 \catcode`\_=\other
7062 \catcode`\|=\other
7063 \catcode`\<=\other
7064 \catcode`\>=\other
7065 \catcode`\+=\other
7066 \catcode`\$=\other
7067 \def\normaldoublequote{"}
7068 \def\normaltilde{~}
7069 \def\normalcaret{^}
7070 \def\normalunderscore{_}
7071 \def\normalverticalbar{|}
7072 \def\normalless{<}
7073 \def\normalgreater{>}
7074 \def\normalplus{+}
7075 \def\normaldollar{$}%$ font-lock fix
7076
7077 % This macro is used to make a character print one way in \tt
7078 % (where it can probably be output as-is), and another way in other fonts,
7079 % where something hairier probably needs to be done.
7080 %
7081 % #1 is what to print if we are indeed using \tt; #2 is what to print
7082 % otherwise. Since all the Computer Modern typewriter fonts have zero
7083 % interword stretch (and shrink), and it is reasonable to expect all
7084 % typewriter fonts to have this, we can check that font parameter.
7085 %
7086 \def\ifusingtt#1#2{\ifdim \fontdimen3\font=0pt #1\else #2\fi}
7087
7088 % Same as above, but check for italic font. Actually this also catches
7089 % non-italic slanted fonts since it is impossible to distinguish them from
7090 % italic fonts. But since this is only used by $ and it uses \sl anyway
7091 % this is not a problem.
7092 \def\ifusingit#1#2{\ifdim \fontdimen1\font>0pt #1\else #2\fi}
7093
7094 % Turn off all special characters except @
7095 % (and those which the user can use as if they were ordinary).
7096 % Most of these we simply print from the \tt font, but for some, we can
7097 % use math or other variants that look better in normal text.
7098
7099 \catcode`\"=\active
7100 \def\activedoublequote{{\tt\char34}}
7101 \let"=\activedoublequote
7102 \catcode`\~=\active
7103 \def~{{\tt\char126}}
7104 \chardef\hat=`\^
7105 \catcode`\^=\active
7106 \def^{{\tt \hat}}
7107
7108 \catcode`\_=\active
7109 \def_{\ifusingtt\normalunderscore\_}
7110 \let\realunder=_
7111 % Subroutine for the previous macro.
7112 \def\_{\leavevmode \kern.07em \vbox{\hrule width.3em height.1ex}\kern .07em }
7113
7114 \catcode`\|=\active
7115 \def|{{\tt\char124}}
7116 \chardef \less=`\<
7117 \catcode`\<=\active
7118 \def<{{\tt \less}}
7119 \chardef \gtr=`\>
7120 \catcode`\>=\active
7121 \def>{{\tt \gtr}}
7122 \catcode`\+=\active
7123 \def+{{\tt \char 43}}
7124 \catcode`\$=\active
7125 \def${\ifusingit{{\sl\$}}\normaldollar}%$ font-lock fix
7126
7127 % If a .fmt file is being used, characters that might appear in a file
7128 % name cannot be active until we have parsed the command line.
7129 % So turn them off again, and have \everyjob (or @setfilename) turn them on.
7130 % \otherifyactive is called near the end of this file.
7131 \def\otherifyactive{\catcode`+=\other \catcode`\_=\other}
7132
7133 % Used sometimes to turn off (effectively) the active characters even after
7134 % parsing them.
7135 \def\turnoffactive{%
7136 \normalturnoffactive
7137 \otherbackslash
7138 }
7139
7140 \catcode`\@=0
7141
7142 % \backslashcurfont outputs one backslash character in current font,
7143 % as in \char`\\.
7144 \global\chardef\backslashcurfont=`\\
7145 \global\let\rawbackslashxx=\backslashcurfont % let existing .??s files work
7146
7147 % \realbackslash is an actual character `\' with catcode other, and
7148 % \doublebackslash is two of them (for the pdf outlines).
7149 {\catcode`\\=\other @gdef@realbackslash{\} @gdef@doublebackslash{\\}}
7150
7151 % In texinfo, backslash is an active character; it prints the backslash
7152 % in fixed width font.
7153 \catcode`\\=\active
7154 @def@normalbackslash{{@tt@backslashcurfont}}
7155 % On startup, @fixbackslash assigns:
7156 % @let \ = @normalbackslash
7157
7158 % \rawbackslash defines an active \ to do \backslashcurfont.
7159 % \otherbackslash defines an active \ to be a literal `\' character with
7160 % catcode other.
7161 @gdef@rawbackslash{@let\=@backslashcurfont}
7162 @gdef@otherbackslash{@let\=@realbackslash}
7163
7164 % Same as @turnoffactive except outputs \ as {\tt\char`\\} instead of
7165 % the literal character `\'.
7166 %
7167 @def@normalturnoffactive{%
7168 @let\=@normalbackslash
7169 @let"=@normaldoublequote
7170 @let~=@normaltilde
7171 @let^=@normalcaret
7172 @let_=@normalunderscore
7173 @let|=@normalverticalbar
7174 @let<=@normalless
7175 @let>=@normalgreater
7176 @let+=@normalplus
7177 @let$=@normaldollar %$ font-lock fix
7178 @unsepspaces
7179 }
7180
7181 % Make _ and + \other characters, temporarily.
7182 % This is canceled by @fixbackslash.
7183 @otherifyactive
7184
7185 % If a .fmt file is being used, we don't want the `\input texinfo' to show up.
7186 % That is what \eatinput is for; after that, the `\' should revert to printing
7187 % a backslash.
7188 %
7189 @gdef@eatinput input texinfo{@fixbackslash}
7190 @global@let\ = @eatinput
7191
7192 % On the other hand, perhaps the file did not have a `\input texinfo'. Then
7193 % the first `\' in the file would cause an error. This macro tries to fix
7194 % that, assuming it is called before the first `\' could plausibly occur.
7195 % Also turn back on active characters that might appear in the input
7196 % file name, in case not using a pre-dumped format.
7197 %
7198 @gdef@fixbackslash{%
7199 @ifx\@eatinput @let\ = @normalbackslash @fi
7200 @catcode`+=@active
7201 @catcode`@_=@active
7202 }
7203
7204 % Say @foo, not \foo, in error messages.
7205 @escapechar = `@@
7206
7207 % These look ok in all fonts, so just make them not special.
7208 @catcode`@& = @other
7209 @catcode`@# = @other
7210 @catcode`@% = @other
7211
7212
7213 @c Local variables:
7214 @c eval: (add-hook 'write-file-hooks 'time-stamp)
7215 @c page-delimiter: "^\\\\message"
7216 @c time-stamp-start: "def\\\\texinfoversion{"
7217 @c time-stamp-format: "%:y-%02m-%02d.%02H"
7218 @c time-stamp-end: "}"
7219 @c End:
7220
7221 @c vim:sw=2:
7222
7223 @ignore
7224 arch-tag: e1b36e32-c96e-4135-a41a-0b2efa2ea115
7225 @end ignore